]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
Version 3.22
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ---
21 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23 installed programs.
24
25 ---
26 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
27
28 ---
29 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
30 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
31 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
32
33 ---
34 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with Lisp code.
35
36 ---
37 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
38 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
39 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
40 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
42 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43 in each user's home directory.
44
45 ---
46 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48 Emacs with Leim.
49
50 +++
51 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
53 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
54 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58 ---
59 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60 the distribution.
61
62 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
67 ---
68 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
69 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
70 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
71 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
72 doesn't automatically select the right one.
73
74 ---
75 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77 ---
78 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
83 ---
84 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
86 ---
87 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
89 ---
90 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
94 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
96 ---
97 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
98
99 ---
100 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
104 ---
105 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
107
108 ---
109 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
110 much pure storage it will approximately need.
111
112 ** The script etc/emacs-buffer.gdb can be used with gdb to retrieve the
113 contents of buffers from a core dump and save them to files easily, should
114 emacs crash.
115
116 ---
117 ** The Emacs terminal emulation in term.el uses a different terminfo name.
118 The Emacs terminal emulation in term.el now uses "eterm-color" as its
119 terminfo name, since term.el now supports color.
120
121 ---
122 ** Emacs Lisp source files are compressed by default if `gzip' is available.
123
124 \f
125 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
126
127 +++
128 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
129 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
130 the fancy startup screen.
131
132 +++
133 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
134 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
135 the blinking cursor.
136
137 +++
138 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
139 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
140
141 +++
142 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
143 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
144 can start with this line:
145
146 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
147
148 +++
149 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
150 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
151 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
152
153 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
154
155 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
156 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
157
158 +++
159 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
160 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
161
162 +++
163 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
164 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
165 an interactively callable function.
166
167 +++
168 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
169 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
170 affects the initial frame.
171
172 +++
173 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
174 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
175 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
176 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
177 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
178
179 +++
180 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
181 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
182 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
183 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
184 `inhibit-splash-screen').
185
186 +++
187 ** The default is now to use an bitmap as the icon, so the command-line options
188 --icon-type, -i has been replaced with options --no-bitmap-icon, -nbi to turn
189 the bitmap icon off.
190
191 +++
192 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
193 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
194 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
195
196 +++
197 ** Init file changes
198 If the init file ~/.emacs does not exist, Emacs will try
199 ~/.emacs.d/init.el or ~/.emacs.d/init.elc. You can also put the shell
200 init file .emacs_SHELL under ~/.emacs.d.
201
202 +++
203 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
204 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
205 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
206 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
207 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
208 \f
209 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
210
211 +++
212 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
213 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
214 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
215 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
216
217 +++
218 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
219 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
220
221 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
222 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
223
224 +++
225 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
226 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
227 the operating system or your X server.
228
229 +++
230 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
231
232 +++
233 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
234 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
235 you about it.
236
237 +++
238 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
239 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
240
241 +++
242 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
243 previous mark if you set `set-mark-command-repeat-pop' to t. I.e. C-u
244 C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC
245 to set the mark immediately after a jump.
246
247 +++
248 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
249 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
250
251 +++
252 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
253
254 See below under "incremental search changes".
255
256 ---
257 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
258
259 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
260 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
261 directory with Dired.
262
263 You can get the old behavior by typing C-x C-f M-n RET, which fetches
264 the actual file name into the minibuffer.
265
266 +++
267 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
268 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
269 it remains unchanged.
270
271 ** When Emacs prompts for file names, SPC no longer completes the file name.
272 This is so filenames with embedded spaces could be input without the
273 need to quote the space with a C-q. The underlying changes in the
274 keymaps that are active in the minibuffer are described below under
275 "New keymaps for typing file names".
276
277 +++
278 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
279 M-o M-o requests refontification.
280
281 +++
282 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
283
284 See below for more details.
285
286 +++
287 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
288 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
289 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
290 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
291 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
292 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
293 \f
294 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
295
296 +++
297 ** !MEM FULL! at the start of the mode line indicates that Emacs
298 cannot get any more memory for Lisp data. This often means it could
299 crash soon if you do things that use more memory. On most systems,
300 killing buffers will get out of this state. If killing buffers does
301 not make !MEM FULL! disappear, you should save your work and start
302 a new Emacs.
303
304 +++
305 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
306 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
307
308 +++
309 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left and
310 (prev-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and C-x right
311 can be used as well.
312
313 +++
314 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
315
316 +++
317 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
318 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
319
320 ---
321 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
322 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
323
324 ---
325 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
326 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
327
328 +++
329 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
330 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
331 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
332 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
333
334 +++
335 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
336 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
337 in Indented-Text mode.
338
339 +++
340 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
341
342 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
343 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
344 in the value, use `$$'.
345
346 +++
347 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
348 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
349 `same-window'.
350
351 +++
352 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
353 from the locale.
354
355 ** The command `list-faces-display' now accepts a prefix arg.
356 When passed, the function prompts for a regular expression and lists
357 only faces matching this regexp.
358
359 ** Mark command changes:
360
361 +++
362 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
363 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
364 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
365
366 +++
367 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
368
369 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
370 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
371 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
372 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
373 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
374 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
375 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
376 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
377 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
378
379 +++
380 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
381
382 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
383 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
384 paragraphs.
385
386 +++
387 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
388 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
389 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
390 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
391 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
392 command only.
393
394 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
395 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
396 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
397 mark or the region.
398
399 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
400 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
401 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
402 C-g.
403
404 +++
405 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
406 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
407 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
408
409 ** Help command changes:
410
411 +++
412 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
413
414 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
415
416 C-h d runs apropos-documentation.
417
418 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
419 that do not change:
420
421 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
422 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
423
424 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
425 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
426
427 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
428 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
429 run by the key sequence.
430 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
431 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
432 that command.
433
434 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
435 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
436 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
437 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
438 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
439 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
440 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
441 new-kill-line is on C-k
442
443 ---
444 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
445 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
446 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
447 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
448
449 +++
450 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
451 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
452
453 +++
454 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
455 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
456 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
457 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
458 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
459 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
460 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node'). In
461 addition, it now makes hyperlinks to URLs as well if the URL is
462 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `URL'.
463
464 +++
465 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
466 description various information about a character, including its
467 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
468 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
469 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
470
471 +++
472 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
473 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
474
475 +++
476 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
477 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
478 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
479 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
480 keyboard oriented alternative.
481
482 +++
483 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
484 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
485 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
486 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
487 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
488
489 +++
490 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
491 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
492 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
493 available.
494
495 +++
496 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
497 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
498 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
499 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
500 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
501 matching item.
502
503 ** Incremental Search changes:
504
505 +++
506 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
507 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
508 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
509 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
510 for details.
511
512 +++
513 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
514 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
515 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
516 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
517
518 +++
519 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
520 at the end of a line.
521
522 +++
523 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
524 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
525 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
526
527 +++
528 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
529 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
530 search string used as the string to replace.
531
532 +++
533 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
534 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
535 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
536
537 ** Replace command changes:
538
539 ---
540 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
541 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
542 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
543
544 +++
545 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
546 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
547 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
548 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
549 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
550 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
551 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
552 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
553 can be edited for each replacement.
554
555 +++
556 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
557 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
558
559 ---
560 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
561 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
562
563 ** File operation changes:
564
565 +++
566 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
567 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
568 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
569 is only rarely needed.
570
571 +++
572 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
573 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
574
575 +++
576 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
577 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
578
579 +++
580 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
581 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
582
583 +++
584 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
585
586 ---
587 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
588
589 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
590 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
591 directory with Dired.
592
593 +++
594 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
595 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
596 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
597 file.)
598
599 +++
600 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
601 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
602
603 +++
604 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
605 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
606 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
607 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
608 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
609 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
610
611 ---
612 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
613 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
614 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
615
616 ---
617 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
618 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
619 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
620
621 +++
622 *** The new option `write-region-inhibit-fsync' disables calls to fsync
623 in `write-region'. This can be useful on laptops to avoid spinning up
624 the hard drive upon each file save. Enabling this variable may result
625 in data loss, use with care.
626
627 +++
628 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
629 Emacs asks for confirmation.
630
631 +++
632 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
633
634 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
635 when visiting the file.
636
637 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
638 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
639 when saving the file.
640
641 +++
642 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
643 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
644 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
645 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
646 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
647 modes do.
648
649 ** Minibuffer changes:
650
651 +++
652 *** The new file-name-shadow-mode is turned ON by default, so that when
653 entering a file name, any prefix which Emacs will ignore is dimmed.
654
655 +++
656 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
657 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
658 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
659 prompt string.
660
661 ---
662 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
663
664 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
665 have in common and where they begin to differ.
666
667 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
668 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
669 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
670 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
671 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
672 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
673 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
674 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
675
676 Above fontification is always done when listing completions is
677 triggered at minibuffer. If you want to fontify completions whose
678 listing is triggered at the other normal buffer, you have to pass
679 the common prefix of completions to `display-completion-list' as
680 its second argument.
681
682 +++
683 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
684 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
685 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
686 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
687 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
688 candidate is a directory.
689
690 +++
691 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
692 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
693 it remains unchanged.
694
695 +++
696 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
697 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
698 elements are deleted.
699
700 ** Redisplay changes:
701
702 +++
703 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
704 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
705 appears between the position information and the major mode.
706
707 +++
708 *** New face `escape-glyph' highlights control characters and escape glyphs.
709
710 +++
711 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now displayed with a special
712 face, either nobreak-space or escape-glyph. You can turn this off or
713 specify a different mode by setting the variable `nobreak-char-display'.
714
715 +++
716 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
717 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
718 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
719 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
720
721 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
722 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
723 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
724 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
725 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
726 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
727
728 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
729 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
730
731 ---
732 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller that
733 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
734 vscroll property.
735
736 +++
737 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
738 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
739 the mode line of the currently selected window.
740
741 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
742 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
743
744 +++
745 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
746 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
747 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
748 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
749 set-fringe-style.
750
751 +++
752 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
753 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
754 the window can be scrolled.
755
756 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
757 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
758 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
759
760 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
761 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
762
763 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presence and
764 position of each bitmap individually.
765
766 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
767 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
768 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
769 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
770
771 +++
772 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
773 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
774 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
775 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
776 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
777
778 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
779 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
780
781 +++
782 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
783 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
784 outside those margins.
785
786 +++
787 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
788 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
789
790 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
791 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
792 or when the frame is resized.
793
794 ** Cursor display changes:
795
796 +++
797 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
798 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
799
800 +++
801 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
802
803 +++
804 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
805 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
806 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
807 cursor does.
808
809 +++
810 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
811 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
812 appears in.
813
814 +++
815 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
816 of the recognized cursor types.
817
818 ** New faces:
819
820 +++
821 *** `mode-line-highlight' is the standard face indicating mouse sensitive
822 elements on mode-line (and header-line) like `highlight' face on text
823 areas.
824
825 +++
826 *** `shadow' face defines the appearance of the "shadowed" text, i.e.
827 the text which should be less noticeable than the surrounding text.
828 This can be achieved by using shades of grey in contrast with either
829 black or white default foreground color. This generic shadow face
830 allows customization of the appearance of shadowed text in one place,
831 so package-specific faces can inherit from it.
832
833 +++
834 *** `vertical-border' face is used for the vertical divider between windows.
835
836 ** Font-Lock changes:
837
838 +++
839 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
840 M-o M-o requests refontification.
841
842 +++
843 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
844 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
845 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
846
847 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
848 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
849 `Info-mode-hook'.
850
851 +++
852 *** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
853 current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
854 The default value is 1.
855
856 +++
857 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
858 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
859 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
860 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
861 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
862
863 +++
864 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
865
866 +++
867 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-comment-delimiter-face'.
868
869 +++
870 *** Easy to overlook single character negation can now be font-locked.
871 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
872 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
873 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
874
875 ---
876 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
877 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
878 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
879 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
880 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
881
882 ---
883 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
884
885 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
886 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
887 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
888 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
889
890 ---
891 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
892
893 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
894 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
895 refontification takes place.
896
897 ** Menu support:
898
899 ---
900 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
901 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
902 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
903 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
904 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
905 current date and time, current line and column number in the mode-line.
906
907 ---
908 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
909
910 ---
911 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
912
913 ---
914 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
915 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
916 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
917
918 +++
919 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
920 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
921
922 ---
923 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
924 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
925
926 +++
927 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
928 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
929 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
930
931 ---
932 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
933 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
934
935 +++
936 *** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
937 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
938 the new dialog.
939
940 ** Mouse changes:
941
942 +++
943 *** If you set the new variable `mouse-autoselect-window' to a non-nil
944 value, windows are automatically selected as you move the mouse from
945 one Emacs window to another, even within a frame. A minibuffer window
946 can be selected only when it is active.
947
948 +++
949 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
950 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
951 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
952 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
953 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
954 to give it focus.
955
956 +++
957 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
958
959 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
960 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
961 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
962 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
963 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
964 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
965
966 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
967 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
968 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
969 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
970 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
971 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
972 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
973 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
974 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
975
976 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
977 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
978 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
979 you release it).
980
981 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
982 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
983
984 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
985 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
986
987 +++
988 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
989 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
990 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
991 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
992 also disable mouse highlighting.
993
994 +++
995 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
996 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
997 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
998
999 ---
1000 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1001 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1002
1003 ---
1004 *** Emacs ignores mouse-2 clicks while the mouse wheel is being moved.
1005
1006 People tend to push the mouse wheel (which counts as a mouse-2 click)
1007 unintentionally while turning the wheel, so these clicks are now
1008 ignored. You can customize this with the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1009 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1010
1011 +++
1012 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
1013
1014 ** Multilingual Environment (Mule) changes:
1015
1016 ---
1017 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
1018 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
1019 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
1020 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
1021 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
1022
1023 +++
1024 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1025 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1026 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1027 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1028 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1029 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1030 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1031 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1032
1033 +++
1034 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
1035 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
1036
1037 +++
1038 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
1039 coding system.
1040
1041 +++
1042 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
1043 of a file.
1044
1045 ---
1046 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1047 unicode.
1048
1049 +++
1050 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1051 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1052 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1053 command.
1054
1055 +++
1056 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1057 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1058
1059 +++
1060 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1061 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1062 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1063 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1064 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1065 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1066 mule-unicode-... ones.
1067
1068 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1069 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1070 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1071 possible.
1072
1073 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1074 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1075 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1076 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1077 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1078
1079 ---
1080 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1081 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1082 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1083 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1084
1085 ---
1086 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1087 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1088 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1089 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1090 automatically according to the locale.)
1091
1092 ---
1093 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1094 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1095 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1096 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1097 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1098 tamil-inscript.
1099
1100 ---
1101 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1102 characters.
1103
1104 ---
1105 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1106 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1107 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1108 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1109 M-f (forward-word)
1110 M-b (backward-word)
1111 M-d (kill-word)
1112 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1113 M-t (transpose-words)
1114 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1115
1116 ---
1117 *** Indian support has been updated.
1118 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1119 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1120 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1121 supported.
1122
1123 ---
1124 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1125
1126 ---
1127 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1128 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1129 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1130 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1131 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1132 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1133 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1134 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1135 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1136 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1137 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1138 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1139
1140 ---
1141 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1142 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1143 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1144
1145 ---
1146 *** Many new coding systems are available in the `code-pages' library.
1147 These include complete versions of most of those in codepage.el, based
1148 on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now obsolete and is used
1149 only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. All coding systems defined in
1150 `code-pages' are auto-loaded.
1151
1152 ---
1153 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1154 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1155
1156 ---
1157 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1158 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1159 fontset appropriately.
1160
1161 ** Customize changes:
1162
1163 +++
1164 *** Custom themes are collections of customize options. Create a
1165 custom theme with M-x customize-create-theme. Use M-x load-theme to
1166 load and enable a theme, and M-x disable-theme to disable it. Use M-x
1167 enable-theme to renable a disabled theme.
1168
1169 +++
1170 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1171 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1172 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1173 faces.
1174
1175 ---
1176 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1177 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1178 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1179 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1180 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1181 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1182 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1183
1184 +++
1185 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1186 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1187 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1188 under the "[State]" button.
1189
1190 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1191
1192 +++
1193 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1194 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
1195 mode.
1196
1197 +++
1198 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1199 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1200 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1201
1202 ---
1203 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1204 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1205 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1206
1207 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1208 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1209 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1210 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1211 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1212
1213 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1214 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1215 t, and the status is shown.
1216
1217 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1218 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1219
1220 ** Dired mode:
1221
1222 ---
1223 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1224 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1225 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1226
1227 +++
1228 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1229 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1230
1231 +++
1232 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1233 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1234
1235 +++
1236 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1237 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1238 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1239 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1240 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1241 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1242
1243 +++
1244 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1245 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1246
1247 +++
1248 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1249
1250 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1251 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1252 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1253 instead.
1254
1255 +++
1256 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1257 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1258 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1259 directory listing into a buffer.
1260
1261 ** Comint changes:
1262
1263 ---
1264 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1265 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1266 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1267 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1268 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1269
1270 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1271 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1272
1273 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1274 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1275 lines, including any prompts.
1276
1277 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1278 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1279 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1280 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1281 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1282 `kill-region' if read-only properties are involved: it copies the text
1283 to the kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1284
1285 +++
1286 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1287 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1288 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1289 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1290
1291 +++
1292 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1293 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1294 but declared obsolete.
1295
1296 ** M-x Compile changes:
1297
1298 ---
1299 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1300
1301 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1302 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1303 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1304 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1305
1306 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1307 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1308 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1309
1310 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1311 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1312 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1313 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1314 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1315
1316 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1317
1318 +++
1319 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1320 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1321 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1322 subprocesses inherit.
1323
1324 +++
1325 *** New user option `compilation-disable-input'.
1326 If this is non-nil, send end-of-file as compilation process input.
1327
1328 +++
1329 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1330 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1331 in new face `next-error'.
1332
1333 +++
1334 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1335 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1336 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1337 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1338 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1339 C-c C-f.
1340
1341 +++
1342 *** When the left fringe is displayed, an arrow points to current message in
1343 the compilation buffer.
1344
1345 +++
1346 *** The new variable `compilation-context-lines' controls lines of leading
1347 context before the current message. If nil and the left fringe is displayed,
1348 it doesn't scroll the compilation output window. If there is no left fringe,
1349 no arrow is displayed and a value of nil means display the message at the top
1350 of the window.
1351
1352 ** Occur mode changes:
1353
1354 +++
1355 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1356 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1357 switching to it.
1358
1359 +++
1360 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1361 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1362
1363 +++
1364 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1365 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1366 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1367 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1368 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1369
1370 ** Grep changes:
1371
1372 +++
1373 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1374
1375 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1376 customization group.
1377
1378 ---
1379 *** M-x grep provides highlighting support.
1380
1381 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1382 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1383
1384 +++
1385 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1386 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1387
1388 ---
1389 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1390 `grep-scroll-output' override the corresponding compilation mode
1391 settings, for grep commands only.
1392
1393 +++
1394 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
1395 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1396 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1397 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1398 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1399 source line is highlighted.
1400
1401 +++
1402 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1403 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1404 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1405 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1406 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1407 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1408 file.
1409
1410 +++
1411 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1412 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1413 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1414 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1415 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1416 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1417
1418 ** X Windows Support:
1419
1420 +++
1421 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1422 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1423 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1424
1425 +++
1426 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1427 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1428 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1429 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1430 Meta and Alt:
1431 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1432 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1433
1434 +++
1435 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1436 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1437
1438 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1439 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1440
1441 ---
1442 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1443 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1444 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1445 and use the more appropriately result.
1446
1447 ---
1448 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1449 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1450 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1451
1452 ** Xterm support:
1453
1454 ---
1455 *** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
1456 display margin, when run in an xterm.
1457
1458 ---
1459 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1460 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1461 following should work:
1462 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1463 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1464 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1465
1466 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1467
1468 +++
1469 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1470 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1471 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1472 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1473 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1474 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1475 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1476 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1477 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1478
1479 ---
1480 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1481 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1482 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1483 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1484 all of these colors.
1485
1486 +++
1487 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1488 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1489 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1490 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1491 colors as on X.
1492
1493 ---
1494 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1495 \f
1496 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1497
1498 ** Rcirc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1499
1500 Rcirc is an Internet relay chat (IRC) client. It supports
1501 simultaneous connections to multiple IRC servers. Each discussion
1502 takes place in its own buffer. For each connection you can join
1503 several channels (many-to-many) and participate in private
1504 (one-to-one) chats. Both channel and private chats are contained in
1505 separate buffers.
1506
1507 To start an IRC session, type M-x irc, and follow the prompts for
1508 server, port, nick and initial channels.
1509
1510 ---
1511 ** Newsticker is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1512
1513 Newsticker asynchronously retrieves headlines (RSS) from a list of news
1514 sites, prepares these headlines for reading, and allows for loading the
1515 corresponding articles in a web browser. Its documentation is in a
1516 separate manual.
1517
1518 +++
1519 ** savehist saves minibuffer histories between sessions.
1520 To use this feature, turn on savehist-mode in your `.emacs' file.
1521
1522 +++
1523 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1524 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1525 program files that include other program files.
1526
1527 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1528 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1529 in them.
1530
1531 +++
1532 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1533
1534 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1535 Emacs Lisp. The prefix for Calc has been changed to `C-x *' and Calc
1536 can be started with `C-x * *'. The Calc manual is separate from the
1537 Emacs manual; within Emacs, type "C-h i m calc RET" to read the
1538 manual. A reference card is available in `etc/calccard.tex' and
1539 `etc/calccard.ps'.
1540
1541 ---
1542 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1543 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1544
1545 ---
1546 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1547
1548 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1549 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1550 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1551 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1552
1553 +++
1554 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1555 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1556
1557 ---
1558 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1559
1560 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1561 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1562 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1563 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1564 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1565 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1566
1567 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1568 rectangle highlighting: Use C-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1569 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1570 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1571
1572 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1573 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1574 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1575 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1576 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1577 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1578 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1579
1580 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1581 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1582 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1583
1584 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1585 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1586
1587 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1588 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1589 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1590 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1591
1592 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1593 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1594 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1595 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1596
1597 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1598 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1599 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1600 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1601
1602 +++
1603 ** Org mode is now part of the Emacs distribution
1604
1605 Org mode is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining ToDo lists, and
1606 doing project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
1607 It also contains a plain-text table editor with spreadsheet-like
1608 capabilities.
1609
1610 The Org mode table editor can be integrated into any major mode by
1611 activating the minor Orgtbl-mode.
1612
1613 The documentation for org-mode is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1614 type "C-h i m org RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1615 available in `etc/orgcard.tex' and `etc/orgcard.ps'.
1616
1617 +++
1618 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1619 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1620 to increment the SOA serial.
1621
1622 ---
1623 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1624 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1625 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1626 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1627 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method can
1628 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1629
1630 +++
1631 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1632 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1633
1634 +++
1635 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1636 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1637 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1638 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1639 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1640
1641 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1642 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1643 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1644 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1645 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1646 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1647
1648 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1649 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1650 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1651 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1652 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1653 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1654 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1655 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1656 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1657 or local keymaps.
1658
1659 +++
1660 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1661 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1662
1663 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1664 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1665 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1666 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1667
1668 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1669 defined macros.
1670
1671 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1672 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1673 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1674 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1675 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1676 for more commands.
1677
1678 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1679 the keyboard macro ring.
1680
1681 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1682 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1683
1684 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1685 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1686 this behavior via the variables kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1687 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1688
1689 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1690 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1691 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1692
1693 ---
1694 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1695 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1696 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1697
1698 +++
1699 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1700 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1701
1702 +++
1703 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1704 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1705 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1706 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1707 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1708 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1709 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1710 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1711 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1712
1713 +++
1714 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1715
1716 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1717 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1718 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1719 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1720 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1721 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1722
1723 ---
1724 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1725 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1726 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1727 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1728
1729 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1730
1731 ---
1732 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1733 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1734 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1735 settings.
1736
1737 +++
1738 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1739 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1740 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1741 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1742
1743 +++
1744 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1745 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1746
1747 +++
1748 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1749 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1750 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1751 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1752 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1753 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1754
1755 ** The tumme.el package allows you to easily view, tag and in other ways
1756 manipulate image files and their thumbnails, using dired as the main interface.
1757 Tumme provides functionality to generate simple image galleries.
1758
1759 +++
1760 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1761
1762 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1763 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1764 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1765 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1766 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1767 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1768 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1769 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1770 `rsync' to do the copying).
1771
1772 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1773 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1774
1775 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1776
1777 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1778
1779 ---
1780 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1781
1782 ---
1783 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1784 configuration files.
1785
1786 +++
1787 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1788 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1789 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1790 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1791 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1792 recognized.
1793
1794 ---
1795 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1796
1797 +++
1798 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1799
1800 ---
1801 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1802 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1803
1804 ** The new package scroll-lock.el provides the Scroll Lock minor mode
1805 for pager-like scrolling. Keys which normally move point by line or
1806 paragraph will scroll the buffer by the respective amount of lines
1807 instead and point will be kept vertically fixed relative to window
1808 boundaries during scrolling.
1809 \f
1810 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1811
1812 ** Changes in Allout
1813
1814 *** Topic cryptography added, enabling easy gpg topic encryption and
1815 decryption. Per-topic basis enables interspersing encrypted-text and
1816 clear-text within a single file to your hearts content, using symmetric
1817 and/or public key modes. Time-limited key caching, user-provided
1818 symmetric key hinting and consistency verification, auto-encryption of
1819 pending topics on save, and more, make it easy to use encryption in
1820 powerful ways.
1821
1822 *** many substantial fixes and refinements, including:
1823
1824 - repaired inhibition of inadvertent edits to concealed text
1825 - repaired retention of topic body hanging indent upon topic depth shifts
1826 - prevent "containment discontinuities" where a topic is shifted deeper
1827 than the offspring-depth of its container
1828 - easy to adopt the distinctive bullet of a topic in a topic created
1829 relative to it, or select a new one, or use the common topic bullet
1830 - plain bullets, by default, now alternate between only two characters
1831 ('.' and ','), yielding less cluttered outlines
1832 - many internal fixes
1833 - version number incremented to 2.1
1834
1835 ** The variable `woman-topic-at-point' was renamed
1836 to `woman-use-topic-at-point' and behaves differently: if this
1837 variable is non-nil, the `woman' command uses the word at point
1838 automatically, without asking for a confirmation. Otherwise, the word
1839 at point is suggested as default, but not inserted at the prompt.
1840
1841 ---
1842 ** Changes to cmuscheme
1843
1844 *** Emacs now offers to start Scheme if the user tries to
1845 evaluate a Scheme expression but no Scheme subprocess is running.
1846
1847 *** If a file `.emacs_NAME' (where NAME is the name of the Scheme interpreter)
1848 exists in the user's home directory or in ~/.emacs.d, its
1849 contents are sent to the Scheme subprocess upon startup.
1850
1851 *** There are new commands to instruct the Scheme interpreter to trace
1852 procedure calls (`scheme-trace-procedure') and to expand syntactic forms
1853 (`scheme-expand-current-form'). The commands actually sent to the Scheme
1854 subprocess are controlled by the user options `scheme-trace-command',
1855 `scheme-untrace-command' and `scheme-expand-current-form'.
1856
1857 ---
1858 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp and BSD make.
1859
1860 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter two
1861 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
1862 faces.
1863
1864 +++
1865 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
1866 of the file that precede the first header line.
1867
1868 +++
1869 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1870
1871 ---
1872 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved; it can
1873 run most curses applications now.
1874
1875 +++
1876 ** M-x diff uses Diff mode instead of Compilation mode.
1877
1878 +++
1879 ** You can now customize `fill-nobreak-predicate' to control where
1880 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1881 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1882
1883 Emacs provide two predicates, `fill-single-word-nobreak-p' and
1884 `fill-french-nobreak-p', for use as the value of
1885 `fill-nobreak-predicate'.
1886
1887 ---
1888 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1889 with special modes such as Tar mode.
1890
1891 ---
1892 ** Commands `winner-redo' and `winner-undo', from winner.el, are now
1893 bound to C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an
1894 incompatible change.
1895
1896 ---
1897 ** `global-whitespace-mode' is a new alias for `whitespace-global-mode'.
1898
1899 +++
1900 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1901 resync points in both windows.
1902
1903 +++
1904 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1905
1906 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1907 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1908
1909 ---
1910 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1911 when Emacs visits them.
1912
1913 ** Info mode changes:
1914
1915 +++
1916 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1917 with the number appended to the `*info*' buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1918
1919 +++
1920 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1921
1922 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1923 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1924 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1925 aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1926 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1927 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
1928 Info node.
1929
1930 ---
1931 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
1932 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
1933 search without prompting for a new search string.
1934
1935 +++
1936 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
1937 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
1938 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
1939
1940 ---
1941 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
1942
1943 ---
1944 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
1945 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
1946
1947 +++
1948 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
1949 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
1950 possible matches.
1951
1952 ---
1953 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
1954 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
1955 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
1956
1957 +++
1958 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
1959 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
1960
1961 ---
1962 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
1963 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
1964
1965 +++
1966 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
1967
1968 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
1969 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
1970
1971 ---
1972 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
1973
1974 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
1975 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
1976 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
1977
1978 +++
1979 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
1980
1981 ---
1982 *** `Info-index' offers completion.
1983
1984 ** Lisp mode changes:
1985
1986 ---
1987 *** Lisp mode now uses `font-lock-doc-face' for doc strings.
1988
1989 +++
1990 *** C-u C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-prints the list after point.
1991
1992 *** New features in evaluation commands
1993
1994 +++
1995 **** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
1996 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
1997
1998 +++
1999 **** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
2000 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
2001 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
2002 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
2003 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
2004
2005 +++
2006 ** CC mode changes.
2007
2008 *** The CC Mode manual has been extensively revised.
2009 The information about using CC Mode has been separated from the larger
2010 and more difficult chapters about configuration.
2011
2012 *** Changes in Key Sequences
2013 **** c-toggle-auto-hungry-state is no longer bound to C-c C-t.
2014
2015 **** c-toggle-hungry-state is no longer bound to C-c C-d.
2016 This binding has been taken over by c-hungry-delete-forwards.
2017
2018 **** c-toggle-auto-state (C-c C-t) has been renamed to c-toggle-auto-newline.
2019 c-toggle-auto-state remains as an alias.
2020
2021 **** The new commands c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forwards
2022 have key bindings C-c C-DEL (or C-c DEL, for the benefit of TTYs) and
2023 C-c C-d (or C-c C-<delete> or C-c <delete>) respectively. These
2024 commands delete entire blocks of whitespace with a single
2025 key-sequence. [N.B. "DEL" is the <backspace> key.]
2026
2027 **** The new command c-toggle-electric-mode is bound to C-c C-l.
2028
2029 **** The new command c-subword-mode is bound to C-c C-w.
2030
2031 *** C-c C-s (`c-show-syntactic-information') now highlights the anchor
2032 position(s).
2033
2034 *** New Minor Modes
2035 **** Electric Minor Mode toggles the electric action of non-alphabetic keys.
2036 The new command c-toggle-electric-mode is bound to C-c C-l. Turning the
2037 mode off can be helpful for editing chaotically indented code and for
2038 users new to CC Mode, who sometimes find electric indentation
2039 disconcerting. Its current state is displayed in the mode line with an
2040 'l', e.g. "C/al".
2041
2042 **** Subword Minor Mode makes Emacs recognize word boundaries at upper case
2043 letters in StudlyCapsIdentifiers. You enable this feature by C-c C-w. It can
2044 also be used in non-CC Mode buffers. :-) Contributed by Masatake YAMATO.
2045
2046 *** New clean-ups
2047
2048 **** `comment-close-slash'.
2049 With this clean-up, a block (i.e. c-style) comment can be terminated by
2050 typing a slash at the start of a line.
2051
2052 **** `c-one-liner-defun'
2053 This clean-up compresses a short enough defun (for example, an AWK
2054 pattern/action pair) onto a single line. "Short enough" is configurable.
2055
2056 *** Font lock support.
2057 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
2058 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
2059 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
2060 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
2061 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
2062 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
2063
2064 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
2065 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
2066 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
2067 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
2068 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
2069 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
2070 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
2071 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
2072 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
2073
2074 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
2075 fontification in mind; Just-In-Time-Lock mode should be enabled for
2076 the highest font lock level (by default, it is). Fontifying a file
2077 with several thousand lines in one go can take the better part of a
2078 minute.
2079
2080 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
2081 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
2082 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
2083 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
2084 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
2085 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
2086
2087 **** Support for documentation comments.
2088 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
2089 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
2090 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
2091 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
2092
2093 Currently three kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Sun's
2094 Javadoc, Autodoc (which is used in Pike) and GtkDoc (used in C). (The
2095 last was contributed by Masatake YAMATO). This is by no means a
2096 complete list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor
2097 of choice is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2098
2099 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
2100 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
2101 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
2102 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
2103 parens.
2104
2105 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
2106 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
2107 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
2108 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
2109 not as configurable as it ought to be.
2110
2111 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
2112 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
2113 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
2114 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
2115 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
2116
2117 *** Support for the AWK language.
2118 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
2119 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
2120 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
2121 Here is a summary:
2122
2123 **** Indentation Engine
2124 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
2125
2126 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
2127 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
2128 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
2129 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
2130 definition, or structured statement.
2131
2132 The predefined line-up functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
2133 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't
2134 be any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
2135
2136 **** Font Locking
2137 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
2138 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
2139 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
2140 the AWK language itself.
2141
2142 **** Comment and Movement Commands
2143 These commands all work for AWK buffers. The notion of "defun" has
2144 been augmented to include AWK pattern-action pairs - the standard
2145 "defun" commands on key sequences C-M-a, C-M-e, and C-M-h use this
2146 extended definition.
2147
2148 **** "awk" style, Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2149 A new style, "awk" has been introduced, and this is now the default
2150 style for AWK code. With auto-newline enabled, the clean-up
2151 c-one-liner-defun (see above) is useful.
2152
2153 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2154 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2155 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2156 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2157 composition-close, and incomposition.
2158
2159 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2160 The new functions `c-hungry-backspace' and `c-hungry-delete-forward'
2161 provide hungry deletion without having to toggle a mode. They are
2162 bound to C-c C-DEL and C-c C-d (and several variants, for the benefit
2163 of different keyboard setups. See "Changes in key sequences" above).
2164
2165 *** Better control over `require-final-newline'.
2166
2167 The variable `c-require-final-newline' specifies which of the modes
2168 implemented by CC mode should insert final newlines. Its value is a
2169 list of modes, and only those modes should do it. By default the list
2170 includes C, C++ and Objective-C modes.
2171
2172 Whichever modes are in this list will set `require-final-newline'
2173 based on `mode-require-final-newline'.
2174
2175 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2176
2177 The elements in the syntactic context returned by `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2178 and stored in `c-syntactic-context' has been changed somewhat to allow
2179 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2180 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2181
2182 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2183
2184 is now analyzed as
2185
2186 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2187
2188 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2189 symbol.
2190
2191 This change might affect code that calls `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2192 directly, and custom lineup functions if they use
2193 `c-syntactic-context'. However, the argument given to lineup
2194 functions is still a single cons cell with nil or an integer in the
2195 cdr.
2196
2197 *** API changes for derived modes.
2198
2199 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2200 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2201 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2202 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2203 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2204
2205 **** New language variable system.
2206 These are variables whose values vary between CC Mode's different
2207 languages. See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2208
2209 **** New initialization functions.
2210 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2211 give better control: `c-basic-common-init', `c-font-lock-init', and
2212 `c-init-language-vars'.
2213
2214 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2215 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2216 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2217 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2218
2219 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2220 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2221 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2222 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2223 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2224
2225 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2226 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2227 its substatement. E.g:
2228
2229 if (x)
2230 x_is_true:
2231 do_stuff();
2232
2233 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2234
2235 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2236 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2237 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2238 variable `c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros'. A new syntactic symbol
2239 `cpp-define-intro' has been added to control the initial indentation
2240 inside `#define's.
2241
2242 **** New lineup function `c-lineup-cpp-define'.
2243
2244 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2245 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2246 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2247 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2248 much line `c-lineup-dont-change', which was used earlier, but handles
2249 empty lines within the macro better.
2250
2251 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2252 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2253 `c-context-line-break' and `c-context-open-line'.
2254
2255 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2256 `c-backslash-region' tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2257 variable `c-backslash-max-column' puts a limit on how far out
2258 backslashes can be moved.
2259
2260 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2261 This is controlled by the new variable `c-auto-align-backslashes'. It
2262 affects `c-context-line-break', `c-context-open-line' and newlines
2263 inserted in Auto-Newline mode.
2264
2265 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2266 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2267 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2268 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2269 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2270 backslash) in the macro.
2271
2272 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2273 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2274 the variable `c-indent-comment-alist'. The indentation behavior is
2275 based on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after
2276 #else and #endif but indentation to `comment-column' in most other
2277 cases (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2278
2279 *** New function `c-context-open-line'.
2280 It's the open-line equivalent of `c-context-line-break'.
2281
2282 *** New lineup functions
2283
2284 **** `c-lineup-string-cont'
2285 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2286 continues. E.g:
2287
2288 result = prefix + "A message "
2289 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2290
2291 **** `c-lineup-cascaded-calls'
2292 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2293
2294 **** `c-lineup-knr-region-comment'
2295 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2296 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2297
2298 **** `c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg'
2299 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks.
2300
2301 **** `c-lineup-argcont'
2302 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2303
2304 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2305 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2306 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2307 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2308 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2309 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2310
2311 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2312 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2313 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2314 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2315 context.
2316
2317 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2318 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2319 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2320 happen when macros are involved.
2321
2322 *** Improved the way `c-indent-exp' chooses the block to indent.
2323 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2324 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2325 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2326 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2327 line is left untouched.
2328
2329 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2330 The function `c-toggle-syntactic-indentation' can be used to toggle
2331 syntactic indentation.
2332
2333 ** In sh-script, a continuation line is only indented if the backslash was
2334 preceded by a SPC or a TAB.
2335
2336 ---
2337 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2338
2339 ---
2340 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2341 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2342 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2343 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2344
2345 ** Fortran mode changes:
2346
2347 ---
2348 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2349 highlighting for the old default.
2350
2351 +++
2352 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2353 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2354 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2355
2356 +++
2357 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2358 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2359 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2360 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2361
2362 ---
2363 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for `hs-minor-mode' (hideshow).
2364 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2365 majority.
2366
2367 ---
2368 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2369 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2370
2371 ---
2372 ** Reftex mode changes
2373 +++
2374 *** Changes to RefTeX's table of contents
2375
2376 The new command keys "<" and ">" in the TOC buffer promote/demote the
2377 section at point or all sections in the current region, with full
2378 support for multifile documents.
2379
2380 The new command `reftex-toc-recenter' (`C-c -') shows the current
2381 section in the TOC buffer without selecting the TOC window.
2382 Recentering can happen automatically in idle time when the option
2383 `reftex-auto-recenter-toc' is turned on. The highlight in the TOC
2384 buffer stays when the focus moves to a different window. A dedicated
2385 frame can show the TOC with the current section always automatically
2386 highlighted. The frame is created and deleted from the toc buffer
2387 with the `d' key.
2388
2389 The toc window can be split off horizontally instead of vertically.
2390 See new option `reftex-toc-split-windows-horizontally'.
2391
2392 Labels can be renamed globally from the table of contents using the
2393 key `M-%'.
2394
2395 The new command `reftex-goto-label' jumps directly to a label
2396 location.
2397
2398 +++
2399 *** Changes related to citations and BibTeX database files
2400
2401 Commands that insert a citation now prompt for optional arguments when
2402 called with a prefix argument. Related new options are
2403 `reftex-cite-prompt-optional-args' and `reftex-cite-cleanup-optional-args'.
2404
2405 The new command `reftex-create-bibtex-file' creates a BibTeX database
2406 with all entries referenced in the current document. The keys "e" and
2407 "E" allow to produce a BibTeX database file from entries marked in a
2408 citation selection buffer.
2409
2410 The command `reftex-citation' uses the word in the buffer before the
2411 cursor as a default search string.
2412
2413 The support for chapterbib has been improved. Different chapters can
2414 now use BibTeX or an explicit `thebibliography' environment.
2415
2416 The macros which specify the bibliography file (like \bibliography)
2417 can be configured with the new option `reftex-bibliography-commands'.
2418
2419 Support for jurabib has been added.
2420
2421 +++
2422 *** Global index matched may be verified with a user function
2423
2424 During global indexing, a user function can verify an index match.
2425 See new option `reftex-index-verify-function'.
2426
2427 +++
2428 *** Parsing documents with many labels can be sped up.
2429
2430 Operating in a document with thousands of labels can be sped up
2431 considerably by allowing RefTeX to derive the type of a label directly
2432 from the label prefix like `eq:' or `fig:'. The option
2433 `reftex-trust-label-prefix' needs to be configured in order to enable
2434 this feature. While the speed-up is significant, this may reduce the
2435 quality of the context offered by RefTeX to describe a label.
2436
2437 +++
2438 *** Miscellaneous changes
2439
2440 The macros which input a file in LaTeX (like \input, \include) can be
2441 configured in the new option `reftex-include-file-commands'.
2442
2443 RefTeX supports global incremental search.
2444
2445 +++
2446 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2447 to support use of font-lock.
2448
2449 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2450
2451 ---
2452 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2453 automatically.
2454
2455 +++
2456 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2457 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2458 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2459 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2460 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2461 from the file name or buffer contents.
2462
2463 +++
2464 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2465
2466 ** TeX modes:
2467
2468 +++
2469 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2470
2471 +++
2472 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2473 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2474 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2475 TeX commands to use at startup.
2476
2477 ---
2478 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2479 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2480
2481 +++
2482 *** New major mode Doctex mode, for *.dtx files.
2483
2484 ** BibTeX mode:
2485
2486 *** The new command `bibtex-url' browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2487 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2488
2489 *** The new command `bibtex-entry-update' (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2490 an existing BibTeX entry.
2491
2492 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2493
2494 *** `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' can take values `plain',
2495 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2496 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2497 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2498 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2499 `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' is non-nil.
2500
2501 *** If the new variable `bibtex-parse-keys-fast' is non-nil,
2502 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2503
2504 *** If the new variable `bibtex-autoadd-commas' is non-nil,
2505 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2506
2507 *** The new variable `bibtex-autofill-types' contains a list of entry
2508 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2509
2510 *** The new command `bibtex-complete' completes word fragment before
2511 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2512
2513 *** The new commands `bibtex-find-entry' and `bibtex-find-crossref'
2514 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2515 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2516
2517 *** In BibTeX mode the command `fill-paragraph' (M-q) fills
2518 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2519
2520 *** The new variables `bibtex-files' and `bibtex-file-path' define a set
2521 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2522
2523 *** The new command `bibtex-validate-globally' checks for duplicate keys
2524 in multiple BibTeX files.
2525
2526 *** The new command `bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill' pushes summary
2527 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2528
2529 +++
2530 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2531 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2532 and `C-c C-r'.
2533
2534 ** GUD changes:
2535
2536 +++
2537 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2538 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2539
2540 ---
2541 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2542 and other common debugger commands.
2543
2544 +++
2545 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2546 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2547 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2548 state of your program. It can separate the input/output of your program from
2549 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2550 Emacs 21/22 such as the toolbar, and bitmaps in the fringe to indicate
2551 breakpoints.
2552
2553 Use M-x gdb to start GDB-UI.
2554
2555 *** The variable tooltip-gud-tips-p has been removed. GUD tooltips can now be
2556 toggled independently of normal tooltips with the minor mode
2557 `gud-tooltip-mode'.
2558
2559 +++
2560 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2561 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2562 not executing.
2563
2564 ---
2565 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2566
2567 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
2568 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
2569 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
2570 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2571 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2572
2573 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2574 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
2575 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2576 (gud-finish).
2577
2578 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2579 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2580
2581 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2582 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2583 Set `gud-jdb-use-classpath' to nil.
2584
2585 Added Customization Variables
2586
2587 *** `gud-jdb-command-name'. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2588
2589 *** `gud-jdb-use-classpath'. Allows selection of java source file searching
2590 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan `gud-jdb-directories' for
2591 java sources (previous method).
2592
2593 *** `gud-jdb-directories'. List of directories to scan and search for java
2594 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2595 is nil).
2596
2597 Minor Improvements
2598
2599 *** The STARTTLS wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2600 instead of the OpenSSL based `starttls' tool. For backwards
2601 compatibility, it prefers `starttls', but you can toggle
2602 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2603 `starttls' tool).
2604
2605 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2606
2607 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2608
2609 +++
2610 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2611
2612 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2613 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2614 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2615 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2616 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2617 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2618 be mode dependent.
2619
2620 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2621 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2622 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2623 toggles this mode.
2624
2625 +++
2626 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2627 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2628 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2629 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2630 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2631 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2632 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2633 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2634 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2635
2636 +++
2637 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2638 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2639 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2640 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2641 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2642
2643 ---
2644 ** recentf changes.
2645
2646 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
2647 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2648 automatic cleanup.
2649
2650 The ten most recent files can be quickly opened by using the shortcut
2651 keys 1 to 9, and 0, when the recent list is displayed in a buffer via
2652 the `recentf-open-files', or `recentf-open-more-files' commands.
2653
2654 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2655 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2656 keep in the recent list.
2657
2658 With the more advanced option `recentf-filename-handlers', you can
2659 specify functions that successively transform recent file names. For
2660 example, if set to `file-truename' plus `abbreviate-file-name', the
2661 same file will not be in the recent list with different symbolic
2662 links, and the file name will be abbreviated.
2663
2664 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2665 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2666 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2667
2668 +++
2669 ** Desktop package
2670
2671 +++
2672 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, `desktop-save-mode'.
2673
2674 +++
2675 *** The variable `desktop-enable' is obsolete.
2676
2677 Customize `desktop-save-mode' to enable desktop saving.
2678
2679 ---
2680 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2681 buffer list.
2682
2683 +++
2684 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers
2685 immediately, remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is
2686 idle).
2687
2688 +++
2689 *** New commands:
2690 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2691 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2692 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2693 it was loaded.
2694 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2695 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2696
2697 ---
2698 *** New customizable variables:
2699 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2700 killed.
2701 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2702 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2703 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2704 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2705 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2706 should not delete.
2707 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2708 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2709 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2710 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2711
2712 +++
2713 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2714
2715 ---
2716 *** New hooks:
2717 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2718 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2719
2720 ---
2721 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2722
2723 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2724 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2725 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2726 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2727 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2728 feature.
2729
2730 ** EDiff changes.
2731
2732 +++
2733 *** When comparing directories.
2734 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2735 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2736 from one directory to another.
2737
2738 +++
2739 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2740 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2741 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2742 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2743 comparison.
2744
2745 +++
2746 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2747 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2748 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2749
2750 +++
2751 ** Etags changes.
2752
2753 *** New regular expressions features
2754
2755 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2756
2757 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2758 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2759 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2760 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2761 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2762 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2763 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2764 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2765 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2766 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2767
2768 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in GCC.
2769
2770 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2771 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2772 CR, TAB, VT,
2773
2774 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2775
2776 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2777 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2778 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2779
2780 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2781
2782 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2783 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2784
2785 *** New language parsing features
2786
2787 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2788
2789 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2790
2791 **** The GCC __attribute__ keyword is now recognized and ignored.
2792
2793 **** New language HTML.
2794
2795 Tags are generated for `title' as well as `h1', `h2', and `h3'. Also,
2796 when `name=' is used inside an anchor and whenever `id=' is used.
2797
2798 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2799
2800 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2801 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2802
2803 **** New language Lua.
2804
2805 All functions are tagged.
2806
2807 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2808
2809 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2810 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2811 package::sub.
2812
2813 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2814
2815 **** New language PHP.
2816
2817 Functions, classes and defines are tags. If the --members option is
2818 specified to etags, variables are tags also.
2819
2820 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2821
2822 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2823 renewenvironment.
2824
2825 *** Honour #line directives.
2826
2827 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2828 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2829 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2830 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2831 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2832
2833 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2834
2835 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2836 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2837 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2838 the file FILE.
2839
2840 ** VC Changes
2841
2842 +++
2843 *** The key C-x C-q only changes the read-only state of the buffer
2844 (toggle-read-only). It no longer checks files in or out.
2845
2846 We made this change because we held a poll and found that many users
2847 were unhappy with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this
2848 behavior, you can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your
2849 `.emacs' file:
2850
2851 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
2852
2853 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
2854
2855 +++
2856 *** The new variable `vc-cvs-global-switches' specifies switches that
2857 are passed to any CVS command invoked by VC.
2858
2859 These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which means they
2860 are inserted before the command name. For example, this allows you to
2861 specify a compression level using the `-z#' option for CVS.
2862
2863 +++
2864 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
2865
2866 +++
2867 *** VC-Annotate mode enhancements
2868
2869 In VC-Annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2870 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2871 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2872
2873 P: annotates the previous revision
2874 N: annotates the next revision
2875 J: annotates the revision at line
2876 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2877 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2878 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2879 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2880
2881 ** pcl-cvs changes:
2882
2883 +++
2884 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2885 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2886 in the repository.
2887
2888 +++
2889 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2890 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2891 `checkout', `update' or `commit'. That means using cvs diff options
2892 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2893
2894 +++
2895 ** The new variable `mail-default-directory' specifies
2896 `default-directory' for mail buffers. This directory is used for
2897 auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to "~/".
2898
2899 +++
2900 ** The mode line can indicate new mail in a directory or file.
2901
2902 See the documentation of the user option
2903 `display-time-mail-directory'.
2904
2905 ** Rmail changes:
2906
2907 ---
2908 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2909
2910 *** The new commands rmail-end-of-message and rmail-summary end-of-message,
2911 by default bound to `/', go to the end of the current mail message in
2912 Rmail and Rmail summary buffers.
2913
2914 +++
2915 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2916
2917 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2918 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2919 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2920 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2921 used instead of the native one.
2922
2923 ** Gnus package
2924
2925 ---
2926 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
2927
2928 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
2929 PGP/MIME.
2930
2931 ---
2932 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
2933
2934 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
2935
2936 ---
2937 ** MH-E changes.
2938
2939 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.85. There have been major changes since
2940 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
2941
2942 ** Calendar changes:
2943
2944 +++
2945 *** You can now use < and >, instead of C-x < and C-x >, to scroll
2946 the calendar left or right. (The old key bindings still work too.)
2947
2948 +++
2949 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
2950 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
2951
2952 +++
2953 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
2954 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
2955 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
2956 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
2957 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
2958 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
2959 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
2960 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
2961 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
2962
2963 +++
2964 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
2965 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
2966 count backward from the end of the year.
2967
2968 +++
2969 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
2970 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
2971 day of that ISO week.
2972
2973 ---
2974 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
2975 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
2976
2977 ---
2978 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
2979 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
2980 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
2981 `christian-holidays' simpler.
2982
2983 ---
2984 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
2985 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
2986 and `diary-header-line-format'.
2987
2988 +++
2989 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed:
2990 use the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
2991 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
2992 `appt-issue-message', `appt-visible', and `appt-msg-window'.
2993
2994 +++
2995 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
2996 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
2997 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
2998 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
2999 formats.
3000
3001 +++
3002 ** Speedbar changes:
3003
3004 *** Speedbar items can now be selected by clicking mouse-1, based on
3005 the `mouse-1-click-follows-link' mechanism.
3006
3007 *** SPC and DEL are no longer bound to scroll up/down in the speedbar
3008 keymap.
3009
3010 *** The new command `speedbar-toggle-line-expansion', bound to SPC,
3011 contracts or expands the line under the cursor.
3012
3013 *** New command `speedbar-create-directory', bound to `M'.
3014
3015 *** The new commands `speedbar-expand-line-descendants' and
3016 `speedbar-contract-line-descendants', bound to `[' and `]'
3017 respectively, expand and contract the line under cursor with all of
3018 its descendents.
3019
3020 *** The new user option `speedbar-query-confirmation-method' controls
3021 how querying is performed for file operations. A value of 'always
3022 means to always query before file operations; 'none-but-delete means
3023 to not query before any file operations, except before a file
3024 deletion.
3025
3026 *** The new user option `speedbar-select-frame-method' specifies how
3027 to select a frame for displaying a file opened with the speedbar. A
3028 value of 'attached means to use the attached frame (the frame that
3029 speedbar was started from.) A number such as 1 or -1 means to pass
3030 that number to `other-frame'.
3031
3032 *** The new user option `speedbar-use-tool-tips-flag', if non-nil,
3033 means to display tool-tips for speedbar items.
3034
3035 *** The frame management code in speedbar.el has been split into a new
3036 `dframe' library. Emacs Lisp code that makes use of the speedbar
3037 should use `dframe-attached-frame' instead of
3038 `speedbar-attached-frame', `dframe-timer' instead of `speedbar-timer',
3039 `dframe-close-frame' instead of `speedbar-close-frame', and
3040 `dframe-activity-change-focus-flag' instead of
3041 `speedbar-activity-change-focus-flag'. The variables
3042 `speedbar-update-speed' and `speedbar-navigating-speed' are also
3043 obsolete; use `dframe-update-speed' instead.
3044
3045 ---
3046 ** sql changes.
3047
3048 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
3049 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
3050 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
3051 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
3052 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
3053
3054 The following values are supported:
3055
3056 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
3057 db2 DB2
3058 informix Informix
3059 ingres Ingres
3060 interbase Interbase
3061 linter Linter
3062 ms Microsoft
3063 mysql MySQL
3064 oracle Oracle
3065 postgres Postgres
3066 solid Solid
3067 sqlite SQLite
3068 sybase Sybase
3069
3070 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
3071 SQL mode indicator.
3072
3073 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
3074 your `.emacs' will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
3075 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
3076
3077 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
3078
3079 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
3080 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
3081 all identifiers ending in `_t' under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
3082 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
3083
3084 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
3085 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
3086
3087 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i.
3088
3089 Most SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
3090 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
3091
3092 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
3093
3094 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
3095 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
3096 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
3097 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
3098 terminated.
3099
3100 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
3101 called with the `-E' command line argument to use the operating system
3102 credentials to authenticate the user.
3103
3104 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
3105 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
3106 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
3107
3108 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
3109 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
3110
3111 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
3112 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
3113 defaults.
3114
3115 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
3116 appropriate `sql-interactive-mode' wrapper for the current setting of
3117 `sql-product'.
3118
3119 ---
3120 *** sql.el supports the SQLite interpreter--call 'sql-sqlite'.
3121
3122 ** FFAP changes:
3123
3124 +++
3125 *** New ffap commands and keybindings:
3126
3127 C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
3128 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
3129 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
3130 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
3131
3132 ---
3133 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default.
3134
3135 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
3136 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
3137
3138 ---
3139 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
3140
3141 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
3142 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
3143 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
3144 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
3145 with other details of skeleton construction.
3146
3147 ---
3148 ** Hideshow mode changes
3149
3150 *** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
3151 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
3152 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
3153 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
3154
3155 *** New variable `hs-allow-nesting' non-nil means that hiding a block does
3156 not discard the hidden state of any "internal" blocks; when the parent
3157 block is later shown, the internal blocks remain hidden. Default is nil.
3158
3159 +++
3160 ** `hide-ifdef-mode' now uses overlays rather than selective-display
3161 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
3162 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
3163
3164 ---
3165 ** `partial-completion-mode' now handles partial completion on directory names.
3166
3167 ---
3168 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
3169 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
3170 you don't want the `.type-break' file in your home directory or are
3171 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
3172
3173 ---
3174 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
3175
3176 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
3177 `ps-print', provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF
3178 fonts. See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
3179
3180 ---
3181 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
3182 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
3183 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
3184 using strokes as an input method.
3185
3186 ** Emacs server changes:
3187
3188 +++
3189 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
3190
3191 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
3192 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
3193 % emacsclient -s foo file1
3194 % emacsclient -s bar file2
3195
3196 +++
3197 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
3198 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given Lisp
3199 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
3200
3201 +++
3202 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
3203
3204 ---
3205 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
3206
3207 +++
3208 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
3209
3210 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
3211 argument it toggles the mode. Turning off PC-Selection mode restores
3212 the global key bindings that were replaced by turning on the mode.
3213
3214 ---
3215 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
3216 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
3217
3218 ---
3219 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
3220
3221 Emacs still works on terminals that require magic cookies in order to
3222 use standout mode, but they can no longer display mode-lines in
3223 inverse-video.
3224
3225 ---
3226 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
3227
3228 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
3229 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
3230 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
3231
3232 ** battery.el changes:
3233
3234 ---
3235 *** display-battery-mode replaces display-battery.
3236
3237 ---
3238 *** battery.el now works on recent versions of OS X.
3239
3240 ---
3241 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode.
3242
3243 To enable this, set `calculator-output-radix' non-nil. In this mode a
3244 separator character is used every few digits, making it easier to see
3245 byte boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the
3246 variable `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
3247
3248 ---
3249 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
3250
3251 ---
3252 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
3253
3254 ---
3255 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
3256 \f
3257 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
3258
3259 +++
3260 ** The HOME directory defaults to Application Data under the user profile.
3261
3262 If you used a previous version of Emacs without setting the HOME
3263 environment variable and a `.emacs' was saved, then Emacs will continue
3264 using C:/ as the default HOME. But if you are installing Emacs afresh,
3265 the default location will be the "Application Data" (or similar
3266 localized name) subdirectory of your user profile. A typical location
3267 of this directory is "C:\Documents and Settings\USERNAME\Application Data",
3268 where USERNAME is your user name.
3269
3270 This change means that users can now have their own `.emacs' files on
3271 shared computers, and the default HOME directory is less likely to be
3272 read-only on computers that are administered by someone else.
3273
3274 +++
3275 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
3276
3277 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
3278 existing values. For example:
3279
3280 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
3281
3282 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
3283 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
3284
3285 ---
3286 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
3287
3288 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
3289 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
3290
3291 ---
3292 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
3293
3294 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
3295
3296 ---
3297 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
3298
3299 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
3300 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
3301 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
3302 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
3303 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
3304 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
3305
3306 ---
3307 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
3308
3309 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
3310 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
3311 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
3312 sound support for those formats.
3313
3314 ---
3315 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
3316
3317 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
3318
3319 ---
3320 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
3321
3322 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
3323 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
3324 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
3325
3326 ---
3327 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
3328
3329 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
3330 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
3331 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
3332 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
3333 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
3334 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
3335 you wish to use them in other faces.
3336
3337 ---
3338 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
3339
3340 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
3341 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
3342 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
3343 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
3344 any customizations.
3345
3346 ---
3347 ** Running in a console window in Windows now uses the console size.
3348
3349 Previous versions of Emacs erred on the side of having a usable Emacs
3350 through telnet, even though that was inconvenient if you use Emacs in
3351 a local console window with a scrollback buffer. The default value of
3352 w32-use-full-screen-buffer is now nil, which favours local console
3353 windows. Recent versions of Windows telnet also work well with this
3354 setting. If you are using an older telnet server then Emacs detects
3355 that the console window dimensions that are reported are not sane, and
3356 defaults to 80x25. If you use such a telnet server regularly at a size
3357 other than 80x25, you can still manually set
3358 w32-use-full-screen-buffer to t.
3359
3360 ---
3361 ** On Mac OS, `keyboard-coding-system' changes based on the keyboard script.
3362
3363 ---
3364 ** The variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
3365 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
3366 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
3367
3368 ** The variable `mac-command-key-is-meta' is obsolete. Use
3369 `mac-command-modifier' and `mac-option-modifier' instead.
3370 \f
3371 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3372
3373 ---
3374 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have
3375 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead.
3376
3377 +++
3378 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3379 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3380 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3381 `undefined'.)
3382
3383 +++
3384 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3385 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3386 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3387
3388 ---
3389 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3390
3391 +++
3392 ** The variable `memory-full' now remains t until
3393 there is no longer a shortage of memory.
3394 \f
3395 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3396
3397 ** General Lisp changes:
3398
3399 *** The function `expt' handles negative exponents differently.
3400 The value for `(expt A B)', if both A and B are integers and B is
3401 negative, is now a float. For example: (expt 2 -2) => 0.25.
3402
3403 +++
3404 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3405
3406 +++
3407 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3408
3409 +++
3410 *** `add-to-list' takes an optional third argument, APPEND.
3411
3412 If APPEND is non-nil, the new element gets added at the end of the
3413 list instead of at the beginning. This change actually occurred in
3414 Emacs 21.1, but was not documented then.
3415
3416 +++
3417 *** New function `add-to-ordered-list' is like `add-to-list' but
3418 associates a numeric ordering of each element added to the list.
3419
3420 +++
3421 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree.
3422
3423 It recursively copyies through both CARs and CDRs.
3424
3425 +++
3426 *** New function `delete-dups' deletes `equal' duplicate elements from a list.
3427
3428 It modifies the list destructively, like `delete'. Of several `equal'
3429 occurrences of an element in the list, the one that's kept is the
3430 first one.
3431
3432 +++
3433 *** New function `rassq-delete-all'.
3434
3435 (rassq-delete-all VALUE ALIST) deletes, from ALIST, each element whose
3436 CDR is `eq' to the specified value.
3437
3438 +++
3439 *** The function `number-sequence' makes a list of equally-separated numbers.
3440
3441 For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9). By
3442 default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different
3443 separation as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns
3444 (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3445
3446 +++
3447 *** New variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'.
3448
3449 They hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3450
3451 +++
3452 *** Minor change in the function `format'.
3453
3454 Some flags that were accepted but not implemented (such as "*") are no
3455 longer accepted.
3456
3457 +++
3458 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer give errors for bad plists.
3459
3460 They return nil for a malformed property list or if the list is
3461 cyclic.
3462
3463 +++
3464 *** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3465
3466 They are like `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare
3467 the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3468
3469 +++
3470 *** New variable `print-continuous-numbering'.
3471
3472 When this is non-nil, successive calls to print functions use a single
3473 numbering scheme for circular structure references. This is only
3474 relevant when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3475
3476 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3477 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3478
3479 +++
3480 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3481
3482 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3483 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3484 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3485
3486 +++
3487 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3488
3489 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3490 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3491 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3492
3493 +++
3494 *** A function or macro's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3495
3496 You put this info in the doc string's last line. It should be
3497 formatted so as to match the regexp "\n\n(fn .*)\\'". If you don't
3498 specify this explicitly, Emacs determines it from the actual argument
3499 names. Usually that default is right, but not always.
3500
3501 +++
3502 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily allows quitting.
3503
3504 A quit inside the body of `with-local-quit' is caught by the
3505 `with-local-quit' form itself, but another quit will happen later once
3506 the code that has inhibitted quitting exits.
3507
3508 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code
3509 inside timer functions and `post-command-hook' functions.
3510
3511 +++
3512 *** New macro `define-obsolete-function-alias'.
3513
3514 This combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3515
3516 +++
3517 *** New function `unsafep' determines whether a Lisp form is safe.
3518
3519 It returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly do anything
3520 dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be unsafe
3521 (calls unknown function, alters global variable, etc).
3522
3523 +++
3524 *** New macro `eval-at-startup' specifies expressions to
3525 evaluate when Emacs starts up. If this is done after startup,
3526 it evaluates those expressions immediately.
3527
3528 This is useful in packages that can be preloaded.
3529
3530 *** `list-faces-display' takes an optional argument, REGEXP.
3531
3532 If it is non-nil, the function lists only faces matching this regexp.
3533
3534 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3535
3536 +++
3537 *** The `defmacro' form can contain indentation and edebug declarations.
3538
3539 These declarations specify how to indent the macro calls in Lisp mode
3540 and how to debug them with Edebug. You write them like this:
3541
3542 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3543
3544 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3545 possible declaration specifiers are:
3546
3547 (indent INDENT)
3548 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3549
3550 (edebug DEBUG)
3551 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3552 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro,
3553 but this is cleaner.)
3554
3555 ---
3556 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3557
3558 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3559
3560 ---
3561 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3562
3563 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3564 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3565 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3566 forms.
3567
3568 +++
3569 ** Variable aliases:
3570
3571 *** New function: defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3572
3573 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3574 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3575 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3576 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3577
3578 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3579 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3580
3581 *** New function: indirect-variable VARIABLE
3582
3583 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3584 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3585 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3586
3587 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3588 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3589
3590 +++
3591 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3592 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3593
3594 ** defcustom changes:
3595
3596 +++
3597 *** The new customization type `float' requires a floating point number.
3598
3599 ** String changes:
3600
3601 +++
3602 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character.
3603
3604 Exception: In a character constant, if it is followed by a `-' in a
3605 character constant (e.g. ?\s-A), it is still interpreted as the super
3606 modifier. In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3607
3608 +++
3609 *** A hex escape in a string constant forces the string to be multibyte.
3610
3611 +++
3612 *** An octal escape in a string constant forces the string to be unibyte.
3613
3614 +++
3615 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3616 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3617 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3618 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3619 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3620
3621 +++
3622 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3623 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3624
3625 +++
3626 *** New function `substring-no-properties' returns a substring without
3627 text properties.
3628
3629 +++
3630 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3631 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3632 been declared obsolete.
3633
3634 +++
3635 ** Displaying warnings to the user.
3636
3637 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning', or the Lisp Manual.
3638 If you want to be sure the warning will not be overlooked, this
3639 facility is much better than using `message', since it displays
3640 warnings in a separate window.
3641
3642 +++
3643 ** Progress reporters.
3644
3645 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3646 progress messages for the user.
3647
3648 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3649 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3650 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3651
3652 ** Buffer positions:
3653
3654 +++
3655 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3656 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3657 the usable window height and width is used.
3658
3659 +++
3660 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3661 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3662 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presence of
3663 large images. To disable this feature, bind the new variable
3664 `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3665
3666 +++
3667 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word' is optional.
3668
3669 It defaults to 1.
3670
3671 +++
3672 *** Argument to `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is optional.
3673
3674 It defaults to 1.
3675
3676 +++
3677 *** New function `mouse-on-link-p' test if a position is in a clickable link.
3678
3679 This is the function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link'
3680 functionality.
3681
3682 +++
3683 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of a position.
3684
3685 It an optional buffer position argument that defaults to point.
3686
3687 +++
3688 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' take new optional argument, LIMIT.
3689
3690 This argument tells them not to search beyond LIMIT. Instead they
3691 give up and return LIMIT.
3692
3693 +++
3694 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3695 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3696 arg is non-nil.
3697
3698 +++
3699 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3700 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3701 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3702
3703 ** Text modification:
3704
3705 +++
3706 *** The new function `insert-for-yank' normally works like `insert', but
3707 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list
3708 and handles the `yank-handler' text property.
3709
3710 +++
3711 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' is like
3712 `insert-for-yank' except that it gets the text from another buffer as
3713 in `insert-buffer-substring'.
3714
3715 +++
3716 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3717 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes all text properties from the
3718 inserted substring.
3719
3720 +++
3721 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3722 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3723 the filtered substring. Use it instead of `buffer-substring' or
3724 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3725 data structure, such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register.
3726
3727 The list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3728 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode adds to
3729 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3730 text.
3731
3732 +++
3733 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3734 argument.
3735
3736 +++
3737 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3738 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3739 be inserted is translated through it.
3740
3741 ---
3742 *** Text clones.
3743
3744 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3745 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3746 clone to the other.
3747
3748 ---
3749 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3750
3751 ** Filling changes.
3752
3753 +++
3754 *** In determining an adaptive fill prefix, Emacs now tries the function in
3755 `adaptive-fill-function' _before_ matching the buffer line against
3756 `adaptive-fill-regexp' rather than _after_ it.
3757
3758 +++
3759 ** Atomic change groups.
3760
3761 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3762 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3763 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3764
3765 (atomic-change-group
3766 (insert foo)
3767 (delete-region x y))
3768
3769 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3770 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3771 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3772 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3773
3774 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3775 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3776
3777 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3778 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3779 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3780 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3781
3782 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3783 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3784 do this.
3785
3786 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3787 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3788 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3789 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3790
3791 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3792 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3793 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3794 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3795 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3796 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3797 twice.
3798
3799 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3800 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3801 returned values, like this:
3802
3803 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3804 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3805
3806 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3807 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3808 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3809
3810 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3811 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3812 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3813 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3814 finished.
3815
3816 ** Buffer-related changes:
3817
3818 ---
3819 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3820
3821 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3822
3823 +++
3824 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3825
3826 +++
3827 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3828 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3829 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3830 value of VARIABLE instead.
3831
3832 *** The function `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' now lets you maintain
3833 various status records in parallel.
3834
3835 It take a variable (a symbol) as argument. If the variable is non-nil,
3836 then its value should be a vector installed previously by
3837 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p'. If the frame names, buffer names, buffer
3838 order, or their read-only or modified flags have changed, since the
3839 time the vector's contents were recorded by a previous call to
3840 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', then the function returns t. Otherwise
3841 it returns nil.
3842
3843 On the first call to `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', the variable's
3844 value should be nil. `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' stores a suitable
3845 vector into the variable and returns t.
3846
3847 If the variable is itself nil, then `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' uses,
3848 for compatibility, an internal variable which exists only for this
3849 purpose.
3850
3851 +++
3852 *** The function `read-buffer' follows the convention for reading from
3853 the minibuffer with a default value: if DEF is non-nil, the minibuffer
3854 prompt provided in PROMPT is edited to show the default value provided
3855 in DEF before the terminal colon and space.
3856
3857 ** Local variables lists:
3858
3859 +++
3860 *** Text properties in local variables.
3861
3862 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3863 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3864
3865 +++
3866 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3867 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3868 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3869 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3870 needed.
3871
3872 ---
3873 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3874 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3875 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3876 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3877 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3878 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3879
3880 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3881 confirmation as before.
3882
3883 ** Searching and matching changes:
3884
3885 +++
3886 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3887 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
3888 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
3889
3890 +++
3891 *** The new variable `search-spaces-regexp' controls how to search
3892 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
3893 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
3894 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
3895
3896 Spaces inside of constructs such as `[..]' and inside loops such as
3897 `*', `+', and `?' are never replaced with `search-spaces-regexp'.
3898
3899 +++
3900 *** New regular expression operators, `\_<' and `\_>'.
3901
3902 These match the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
3903 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
3904 specified by the syntax table.
3905
3906 ---
3907 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
3908
3909 +++
3910 *** `skip-chars-forward' and `skip-chars-backward' now handle
3911 character classes such as `[:alpha:]', along with individual
3912 characters and ranges.
3913
3914 ---
3915 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3916 properties from surrounding text.
3917
3918 +++
3919 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3920 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3921 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
3922
3923 +++
3924 *** Functions `match-data' and `set-match-data' now have an optional
3925 argument `reseat'. When non-nil, all markers in the match data list
3926 passed to these function will be reseated to point to nowhere.
3927
3928 +++
3929 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3930 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
3931 that end a sentence without following spaces.
3932
3933 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
3934 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
3935 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3936 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3937 `sentence-end-without-space'.
3938
3939 ** Undo changes:
3940
3941 +++
3942 *** `buffer-undo-list' can allows programmable elements.
3943
3944 These elements have the form (apply FUNNAME . ARGS), where FUNNAME is
3945 a symbol other than t or nil. That stands for a high-level change
3946 that should be undone by evaluating (apply FUNNAME ARGS).
3947
3948 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
3949 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
3950 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
3951
3952 +++
3953 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
3954 `undo-outer-limit', garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
3955 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
3956
3957 +++
3958 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
3959 previously killed text on the kill ring is reinserted.
3960
3961 The value of the `yank-handler' property must be a list with one to four
3962 elements with the following format:
3963 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3964
3965 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3966 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3967 element on the kill-ring). If a `yank-handler' property is found,
3968 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3969
3970 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3971 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3972 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3973 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3974 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3975 rectangle.
3976 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3977 `yank-excluded-properties' is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3978 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3979 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3980 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3981 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
3982 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
3983 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
3984
3985 *** The functions `kill-new', `kill-append', and `kill-region' now have an
3986 optional argument to specify the `yank-handler' text property to put on
3987 the killed text.
3988
3989 *** The function `yank-pop' will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3990 `yank-undo-function' (instead of `delete-region') to undo the previous
3991 `yank' or `yank-pop' command (or a call to `insert-for-yank'). The function
3992 `insert-for-yank' automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3993 element of the string argument's `yank-handler' text property if present.
3994
3995 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
3996 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
3997 string. The old behavior is available if you call
3998 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
3999
4000 ** Syntax table changes:
4001
4002 +++
4003 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' no longer copies the syntax table.
4004
4005 +++
4006 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
4007 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
4008 of text properties as well as the character code.
4009
4010 +++
4011 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
4012 by `syntax-after').
4013
4014 +++
4015 *** The new function `syntax-ppss' rovides an efficient way to find the
4016 current syntactic context at point.
4017
4018 ** File operation changes:
4019
4020 +++
4021 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
4022 searching for an executable or an Emacs Lisp file.
4023
4024 +++
4025 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
4026 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
4027 operation.
4028
4029 +++
4030 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
4031 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
4032 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
4033 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
4034
4035 +++
4036 *** `buffer-auto-save-file-format' is the new name for what was
4037 formerly called `auto-save-file-format'. It is now a permanent local.
4038
4039 +++
4040 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
4041 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
4042 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
4043
4044 +++
4045 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
4046
4047 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
4048
4049 +++
4050 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
4051 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
4052
4053 +++
4054 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
4055 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
4056 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
4057 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
4058
4059 +++
4060 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
4061 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
4062 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
4063 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
4064
4065 +++
4066 *** If `buffer-save-without-query' is non-nil in some buffer,
4067 `save-some-buffers' will always save that buffer without asking (if
4068 it's modified).
4069
4070 +++
4071 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
4072 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
4073 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
4074 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
4075 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
4076 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
4077 further filter candidate files.
4078
4079 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
4080 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
4081 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependancies.
4082
4083 ---
4084 *** The precedence of file name handlers has been changed.
4085
4086 Instead of choosing the first handler that matches,
4087 `find-file-name-handler' now gives precedence to a file name handler
4088 that matches nearest the end of the file name. More precisely, the
4089 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen. In case
4090 of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
4091
4092 +++
4093 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
4094
4095 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
4096 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
4097 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
4098 operations.
4099
4100 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
4101 autoloaded when not really necessary.
4102
4103 +++
4104 *** The function `make-auto-save-file-name' is now handled by file
4105 name handlers. This will be exploited for remote files mainly.
4106
4107 ** Input changes:
4108
4109 +++
4110 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
4111 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
4112 previous `k' or `K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
4113
4114 +++
4115 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
4116 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
4117 it returns just the directory name.
4118
4119 ---
4120 *** Functions `y-or-n-p', `read-char', `read-key-sequence' and the like, that
4121 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
4122 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
4123
4124 +++
4125 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
4126 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
4127 quit had occurred. `while-no-input' returns the value of BODY, if BODY
4128 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted by a quit, and t if
4129 BODY was aborted by arrival of input.
4130
4131 ** Minibuffer changes:
4132
4133 +++
4134 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
4135 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
4136 defaults to the current buffer.
4137
4138 +++
4139 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
4140 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
4141
4142 +++
4143 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
4144 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
4145
4146 +++
4147 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
4148 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
4149 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
4150 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
4151 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
4152
4153 ---
4154 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by Lisp code
4155 to override the built-in `read-file-name' function.
4156
4157 +++
4158 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
4159 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
4160 `read-file-name' function.
4161
4162 +++
4163 *** The new function `read-directory-name' for reading a directory name.
4164
4165 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
4166 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
4167
4168 ** Completion changes:
4169
4170 +++
4171 *** The functions `all-completions' and `try-completion' now accept lists
4172 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
4173 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
4174 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
4175 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
4176
4177 +++
4178 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
4179 as a dynamic completion table.
4180
4181 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
4182
4183 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
4184 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
4185 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
4186 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
4187 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
4188 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
4189
4190 +++
4191 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
4192 as a lazy completion table.
4193
4194 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
4195
4196 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
4197 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
4198 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
4199 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
4200 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
4201 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
4202
4203 +++
4204 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
4205
4206 *** New keymaps for typing file names
4207
4208 Two new keymaps, `minibuffer-local-filename-completion-map' and
4209 `minibuffer-local-must-match-filename-map', apply whenever
4210 Emacs reads a file name in the minibuffer. These key maps override
4211 the usual binding of SPC to `minibuffer-complete-word' (so that file
4212 names with embedded spaces could be typed without the need to quote
4213 the spaces).
4214
4215 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
4216
4217 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
4218 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
4219 example,
4220
4221 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
4222
4223 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
4224
4225 This is an alternative to using `defadvice' or `substitute-key-definition'
4226 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
4227 binding and lookup functionality.
4228
4229 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
4230 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
4231 original command.
4232
4233 Example:
4234 Suppose that minor mode `my-mode' has defined the commands
4235 `my-kill-line' and `my-kill-word', and it wants C-k (and any other key
4236 bound to `kill-line') to run the command `my-kill-line' instead of
4237 `kill-line', and likewise it wants to run `my-kill-word' instead of
4238 `kill-word'.
4239
4240 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
4241 command remapping allows you to directly map `kill-line' into
4242 `my-kill-line' and `kill-word' into `my-kill-word' using `define-key':
4243
4244 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
4245 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
4246
4247 When `my-mode' is enabled, its minor mode keymap is enabled too. So
4248 when the user types C-k, that runs the command `my-kill-line'.
4249
4250 Only one level of remapping is supported. In the above example, this
4251 means that if `my-kill-line' is remapped to `other-kill', then C-k still
4252 runs `my-kill-line'.
4253
4254 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
4255
4256 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
4257 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
4258 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
4259 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
4260
4261 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
4262 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
4263
4264 - `key-binding' now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
4265 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
4266
4267 - `where-is-internal' now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
4268 `kill-line', when `my-mode' is enabled), and the actual key binding for
4269 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
4270 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
4271 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns "C-k" for `kill-line', and
4272 "<kill-line>" for `my-kill-line').
4273
4274 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
4275 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
4276 command was not remapped.
4277
4278 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
4279 over minor mode keymaps.
4280
4281 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
4282 text properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
4283 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
4284
4285 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
4286
4287 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
4288 bindings of the parent keymap.
4289
4290 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
4291
4292 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
4293 active keymaps.
4294
4295 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
4296 defined keys and their definitions.
4297
4298 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt string of a keymap.
4299
4300 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
4301 in the keymap.
4302
4303 *** New variable `emulation-mode-map-alists'.
4304
4305 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
4306 keymap alist separate from `minor-mode-map-alist' by adding their
4307 keymap alist to this list.
4308
4309 ** Abbrev changes:
4310
4311 +++
4312 *** The new function `copy-abbrev-table' copies an abbrev table.
4313
4314 It returns a new abbrev table that is a copy of a given abbrev table.
4315
4316 +++
4317 *** `define-abbrev' now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG.
4318
4319 If non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means
4320 that it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the
4321 abbrevs. Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always
4322 specify this flag.
4323
4324 +++
4325 ** Enhancements to process support
4326
4327 *** Function `list-processes' now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
4328 it lists only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set.
4329
4330 *** New fns `set-process-query-on-exit-flag' and `process-query-on-exit-flag'.
4331
4332 These replace the old function `process-kill-without-query'. That
4333 function is still supported, but new code should use the new
4334 functions.
4335
4336 *** Function `signal-process' now accepts a process object or process
4337 name in addition to a process id to identify the signaled process.
4338
4339 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
4340 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
4341
4342 Use the new functions `process-get' and `process-put' to access, add,
4343 and modify elements on this property list. Use the new functions
4344 `process-plist' and `set-process-plist' to access and replace the
4345 entire property list of a process.
4346
4347 *** Function `accept-process-output' has a new optional fourth arg
4348 JUST-THIS-ONE. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
4349 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
4350 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
4351 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
4352 speech synthesis.
4353
4354 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
4355
4356 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
4357 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
4358 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
4359 by setting the new variable `process-adaptive-read-buffering' to a
4360 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
4361 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
4362 emacs tries to read it.
4363
4364 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
4365
4366 This executes a shell command synchronously in a separate process.
4367
4368 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
4369 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
4370 `default-directory'.
4371
4372 *** A process filter function gets the output as multibyte string
4373 if the process specifies t for its filter's multibyteness.
4374
4375 That multibyteness is decided by the value of
4376 `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is created, and
4377 you can change it later with `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
4378
4379 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
4380 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4381
4382 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
4383 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4384
4385 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
4386 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
4387 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
4388 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
4389 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
4390
4391 +++
4392 ** Enhanced networking support.
4393
4394 *** The new `make-network-process' function makes network connections.
4395 It allows opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
4396 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
4397
4398 - A server is started using :server t arg.
4399 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
4400 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
4401 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
4402 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
4403 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
4404 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
4405 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
4406
4407 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
4408 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
4409
4410 *** The old `open-network-stream' now uses `make-network-process'.
4411
4412 *** New functions `process-datagram-address', `set-process-datagram-address'.
4413
4414 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
4415 and set the current address of the remote partner.
4416
4417 *** New function `format-network-address'.
4418
4419 This function reformats the Lisp representation of a network address
4420 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
4421 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
4422 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
4423 string for other formatting options.
4424
4425 *** `process-contact' has an optional KEY argument.
4426
4427 Depending on this argument, you can get the complete list of network
4428 process properties or a specific property. Using :local or :remote as
4429 the KEY, you get the address of the local or remote end-point.
4430
4431 An Inet address is represented as a 5 element vector, where the first
4432 4 elements contain the IP address and the fifth is the port number.
4433
4434 *** New functions `stop-process' and `continue-process'.
4435
4436 These functions stop and restart communication through a network
4437 connection. For a server process, no connections are accepted in the
4438 stopped state. For a client process, no input is received in the
4439 stopped state.
4440
4441 *** New function `network-interface-list'.
4442
4443 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
4444 current network addresses.
4445
4446 *** New function `network-interface-info'.
4447
4448 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
4449 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4450
4451 *** Deleting a network process with `delete-process' calls the sentinel.
4452
4453 The status message passed to the sentinel for a deleted network
4454 process is "deleted". The message passed to the sentinel when the
4455 connection is closed by the remote peer has been changed to
4456 "connection broken by remote peer".
4457
4458 ** Using window objects:
4459
4460 +++
4461 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4462
4463 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
4464 header line.
4465
4466 +++
4467 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4468
4469 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line
4470 or the header line.
4471
4472 +++
4473 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4474
4475 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4476 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4477 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4478 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4479 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4480
4481 +++
4482 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
4483 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
4484 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
4485 the mode line.
4486
4487 +++
4488 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
4489 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
4490
4491 +++
4492 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
4493 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
4494 It saves and restores the current buffer, too.
4495
4496 +++
4497 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument NORECORD.
4498
4499 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
4500
4501 +++
4502 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4503 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4504 by calling `select-window'. It also saves and restores the current
4505 buffer.
4506
4507 +++
4508 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4509
4510 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4511 and scroll-bar settings.
4512
4513 +++
4514 *** The new function `window-tree' returns a frame's window tree.
4515
4516 +++
4517 *** The functions `get-lru-window' and `get-largest-window' take an optional
4518 argument `dedicated'. If non-nil, those functions do not ignore
4519 dedicated windows.
4520
4521 +++
4522 *** The new function `adjust-window-trailing-edge' moves the right
4523 or bottom edge of a window. It does not move other window edges.
4524
4525 +++
4526 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4527
4528 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4529 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4530
4531 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4532 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
4533
4534 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4535 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4536
4537 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' specifies the face to be
4538 used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is automatically merged
4539 with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face should only specify the
4540 foreground color of the bitmap.
4541
4542 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe' and `right-fringe',
4543 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4544 bitmap of the display line.
4545
4546 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4547 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4548 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4549 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4550 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4551
4552 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4553 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4554
4555 ** Other window fringe features:
4556
4557 +++
4558 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4559
4560 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4561 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4562 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4563 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4564
4565 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4566 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4567 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4568 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
4569 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4570 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4571
4572 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4573 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4574 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4575 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4576
4577 +++
4578 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4579
4580 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4581 position settings.
4582
4583 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4584 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4585 `set-window-fringes'.
4586
4587 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4588 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4589 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4590 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4591
4592 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4593 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4594 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4595 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4596 an update of the display margins.
4597
4598 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4599 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4600
4601 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4602 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4603 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4604 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4605 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4606 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4607 of the display margins.
4608
4609 ** Redisplay features:
4610
4611 +++
4612 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4613
4614 +++
4615 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4616 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4617 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4618 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4619 forcing an explicit window update.
4620
4621 +++
4622 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4623 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4624 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4625
4626 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4627 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4628
4629 +++
4630 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4631 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4632
4633 It contains a list of varibles which contain overlay arrow position
4634 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4635
4636 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4637 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4638 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4639 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4640 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4641 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4642
4643 +++
4644 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4645
4646 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4647 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4648
4649 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4650 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4651 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4652 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4653 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4654
4655 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4656 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4657 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4658
4659 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4660 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4661 the given value.
4662
4663 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4664 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4665 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4666
4667 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4668 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4669
4670 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4671 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4672 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4673 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4674 exactly that many pixels high.
4675
4676 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4677 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4678 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4679 the `line-spacing' variable.
4680
4681 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4682 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4683
4684 +++
4685 *** The buffer local `line-spacing' variable can now have a float value,
4686 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4687
4688 +++
4689 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4690
4691 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4692 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
4693 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4694
4695 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4696 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4697 are supported:
4698
4699 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4700 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4701 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4702 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4703 | scroll-bar | text
4704 POS ::= left | center | right
4705 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4706 OP ::= + | -
4707
4708 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4709 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4710 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4711 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4712 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4713 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4714 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4715 the image.
4716
4717 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4718 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4719 corresponding area of the window.
4720
4721 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4722 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4723 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4724 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4725 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4726 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4727 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
4728 the width of the area.
4729
4730 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4731 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4732
4733 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4734 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4735 header line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4736
4737 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4738 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4739 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4740 height) of the specified image.
4741
4742 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4743 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4744
4745 +++
4746 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4747 text property string that may be present at the current window
4748 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4749 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4750
4751 +++
4752 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4753 supported on text terminals.
4754
4755 +++
4756 *** Support for displaying image slices
4757
4758 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4759 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4760
4761 **** Function `insert-image' has new optional fourth arg to
4762 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4763
4764 **** New function `insert-sliced-image' inserts a given image as a
4765 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4766
4767 +++
4768 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4769
4770 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4771 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4772 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4773 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4774 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4775 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4776 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4777 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4778
4779 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4780 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4781 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4782 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4783 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable `void-area-text-pointer'
4784 for possible pointer shapes.
4785
4786 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4787 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4788 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4789
4790 +++
4791 *** The function `find-image' now searches in etc/images/ and etc/.
4792 The new variable `image-load-path' is a list of locations in which to
4793 search for image files. The default is to search in etc/images, then
4794 in etc/, and finally in the directories specified by `load-path'.
4795 Subdirectories of etc/ and etc/images are not recursively searched; if
4796 you put an image file in a subdirectory, you have to specify it
4797 explicitly; for example, if an image is put in etc/images/foo/bar.xpm:
4798
4799 (defimage foo-image '((:type xpm :file "foo/bar.xpm")))
4800
4801 +++
4802 *** The new variable `max-image-size' defines the maximum size of
4803 images that Emacs will load and display.
4804
4805 ** Mouse pointer features:
4806
4807 +++ (lispref)
4808 ??? (man)
4809 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4810 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4811 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4812 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4813 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4814
4815 +++
4816 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4817 :pointer image property.
4818
4819 +++
4820 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4821 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
4822
4823 ** Mouse event enhancements:
4824
4825 +++
4826 *** Mouse events for clicks on window fringes now specify `left-fringe'
4827 or `right-fringe' as the area.
4828
4829 +++
4830 *** All mouse events now include a buffer position regardless of where
4831 you clicked. For mouse clicks in window margins and fringes, this is
4832 a sensible buffer position corresponding to the surrounding text.
4833
4834 +++
4835 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
4836
4837 +++
4838 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
4839
4840 +++
4841 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4842 text area).
4843
4844 +++
4845 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types
4846 and all areas.
4847
4848 +++
4849 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns the actual glyph coordinates
4850 of the mouse event position.
4851
4852 +++
4853 *** Mouse events can now indicate an image object clicked on.
4854
4855 +++
4856 *** Mouse events include relative X and Y pixel coordinates relative to
4857 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
4858
4859 +++
4860 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
4861 (image or character) clicked on.
4862
4863 +++
4864 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', 'posn-object-width-height'.
4865
4866 These return the image or string object of a mouse click, the X and Y
4867 pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner of that object, and
4868 the total width and height of that object.
4869
4870 ** Text property and overlay changes:
4871
4872 +++
4873 *** Arguments for `remove-overlays' are now optional, so that you can
4874 remove all overlays in the buffer with just (remove-overlays).
4875
4876 +++
4877 *** New variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4878
4879 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
4880 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
4881 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
4882 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
4883
4884 +++
4885 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
4886 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
4887 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
4888 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
4889 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
4890
4891 +++
4892 *** The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties'.
4893
4894 It is like `remove-text-properties' except that it takes a list of
4895 property names as argument rather than a property list.
4896
4897 ** Face changes
4898
4899 +++
4900 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
4901 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
4902 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
4903 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
4904 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
4905 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
4906
4907 +++
4908 *** New function `display-supports-face-attributes-p' can be used to test
4909 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
4910
4911 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
4912 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
4913 defined with `defface'.
4914
4915 ---
4916 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4917 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
4918 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4919 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4920 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
4921
4922 +++
4923 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
4924 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
4925 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
4926 by them).
4927
4928 +++
4929 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
4930 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
4931 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
4932 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
4933 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
4934
4935 ---
4936 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
4937 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
4938 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
4939
4940 +++
4941 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', `face-stipple'.
4942
4943 These now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how
4944 face inheritance is used when determining the value of a face
4945 attribute.
4946
4947 +++
4948 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
4949 help with handling relative face attributes.
4950
4951 +++
4952 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
4953
4954 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
4955 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
4956 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
4957 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
4958 `face' properties.
4959
4960 ---
4961 *** On terminals, faces with the :inverse-video attribute are displayed
4962 with swapped foreground and background colors even when one of them is
4963 not specified. In previous releases of Emacs, if either foreground
4964 or background color was unspecified, colors were not swapped. This
4965 was inconsistent with the face behavior under X.
4966
4967 ---
4968 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
4969 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
4970
4971 ** Font-Lock changes:
4972
4973 +++
4974 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
4975
4976 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
4977 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
4978 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
4979 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4980
4981 +++
4982 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
4983
4984 **** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
4985 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
4986 properties than `face'.
4987
4988 **** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
4989 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
4990
4991 ---
4992 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
4993
4994 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
4995 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
4996 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
4997 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
4998 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
4999
5000 s{
5001 foo
5002 }{
5003 bar
5004 }e
5005
5006 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
5007 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
5008 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
5009 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
5010
5011 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
5012
5013 +++
5014 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
5015 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
5016 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
5017 var `magic-mode-alist'.
5018
5019 +++
5020 *** Use the new function `run-mode-hooks' to run the major mode's mode hook.
5021
5022 +++
5023 *** All major mode functions should now run the new normal hook
5024 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode
5025 hooks. `run-mode-hooks' does this automatically.
5026
5027 ---
5028 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
5029 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
5030 it in that buffer.
5031
5032 +++
5033 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
5034 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
5035 the language.
5036
5037 +++
5038 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
5039 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
5040
5041 +++
5042 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
5043 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
5044 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
5045
5046 ** Minor mode changes:
5047
5048 +++
5049 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
5050 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
5051
5052 +++
5053 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
5054
5055 +++
5056 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
5057
5058 This is a new name for what was formerly called
5059 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
5060
5061 ** Command loop changes:
5062
5063 +++
5064 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
5065 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' to do: it returns t if the
5066 calling function was called through `call-interactively'.
5067
5068 Only use this when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
5069 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
5070
5071 +++
5072 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
5073
5074 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
5075 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
5076 macros.
5077
5078 +++
5079 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
5080 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
5081 covered by an image or composition property.
5082
5083 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
5084 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
5085 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
5086 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
5087 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
5088
5089 +++
5090 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
5091 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
5092 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
5093 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
5094 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
5095
5096 +++
5097 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
5098 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
5099 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
5100
5101 +++
5102 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
5103 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
5104
5105 ** Lisp file loading changes:
5106
5107 +++
5108 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
5109 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
5110 current file redefined it).
5111
5112 +++
5113 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
5114 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
5115
5116 +++
5117 *** The function `symbol-file' can now search specifically for function,
5118 variable or face definitions.
5119
5120 +++
5121 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
5122 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
5123 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
5124
5125 ---
5126 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
5127 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
5128 than 3 levels of nesting.
5129
5130 +++
5131 ** Byte compiler changes:
5132
5133 *** The byte compiler now displays the actual line and character
5134 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
5135 warning and error messages have been brought into line with GNU standards
5136 for these. As a result, you can use next-error and friends on the
5137 compilation output buffer.
5138
5139 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
5140 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
5141
5142 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
5143 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
5144 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
5145 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
5146 forms:
5147
5148 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
5149 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
5150
5151 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
5152 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
5153 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
5154 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
5155 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
5156 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
5157
5158 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
5159 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
5160 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
5161 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
5162 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
5163 you anything.
5164
5165 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in Lisp files is now obeyed.
5166
5167 ---
5168 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
5169 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
5170 (require 'cl) when loaded.
5171
5172 ** Frame operations:
5173
5174 +++
5175 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
5176
5177 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
5178 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
5179
5180 +++
5181 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
5182 for all (existing and future) frames.
5183
5184 +++
5185 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
5186 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
5187 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
5188 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
5189
5190 +++
5191 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
5192 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
5193
5194 ** Mule changes:
5195
5196 +++
5197 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
5198
5199 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
5200 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
5201 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
5202 now:
5203
5204 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
5205
5206 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
5207 the time it takes to convert the format.
5208
5209 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
5210 wasteful.
5211
5212 ---
5213 *** `set-buffer-file-coding-system' now takes an additional argument,
5214 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
5215
5216 +++
5217 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
5218 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
5219 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
5220 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
5221
5222 ---
5223 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
5224 of one coding system from another coding system.
5225
5226 ---
5227 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
5228 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
5229 parts, e.g. utf-16.
5230
5231 +++
5232 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
5233 it is read from a file without decoding.
5234
5235 ---
5236 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
5237 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
5238
5239 ---
5240 *** New function `quail-find-key' returns a list of keys to type in the
5241 current input method to input a character.
5242
5243 ** Mode line changes:
5244
5245 +++
5246 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
5247
5248 This returns the mode line or header line of the selected (or a
5249 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
5250
5251 +++
5252 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
5253 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
5254
5255 +++
5256 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
5257 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
5258 line.
5259
5260 +++
5261 *** Mouse-face on mode-line (and header-line) is now supported.
5262
5263 ** Menu manipulation changes:
5264
5265 ---
5266 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
5267 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
5268 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
5269 several versions ago.
5270
5271 ---
5272 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
5273 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
5274 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
5275
5276 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
5277 made with easy-menu.
5278
5279 ---
5280 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
5281 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
5282 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
5283 need to have a name.
5284
5285 ** Operating system access:
5286
5287 +++
5288 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
5289 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
5290
5291 +++
5292 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
5293 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
5294 accepts a float as UID parameter.
5295
5296 +++
5297 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
5298
5299 ---
5300 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
5301 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
5302 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
5303
5304 ---
5305 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
5306 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
5307
5308 ** Miscellaneous:
5309
5310 +++
5311 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
5312
5313 `find-file-hooks' to `find-file-hook',
5314 `find-file-not-found-hooks' to `find-file-not-found-functions',
5315 `write-file-hooks' to `write-file-functions',
5316 `write-contents-hooks' to `write-contents-functions',
5317 `x-lost-selection-hooks' to `x-lost-selection-functions',
5318 `x-sent-selection-hooks' to `x-sent-selection-functions',
5319 `delete-frame-hook' to `delete-frame-functions'.
5320
5321 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
5322
5323 +++
5324 *** local-write-file-hooks is marked obsolete
5325
5326 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
5327
5328 ---
5329 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
5330 running under X.
5331
5332 ** GC changes:
5333
5334 +++
5335 *** New variable `gc-cons-percentage' automatically grows the GC cons threshold
5336 as the heap size increases.
5337
5338 +++
5339 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
5340 on garbage collection.
5341
5342 +++
5343 *** The normal hook `post-gc-hook' is run at the end of garbage collection.
5344
5345 The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
5346 \f
5347 * New Packages for Lisp Programming in Emacs 22.1
5348
5349 +++
5350 ** The new library button.el implements simple and fast `clickable
5351 buttons' in emacs buffers. Buttons are much lighter-weight than the
5352 `widgets' implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that
5353 doesn't require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for
5354 such things as help and apropos buffers.
5355
5356 ---
5357 ** The new library tree-widget.el provides a widget to display a set
5358 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
5359 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
5360
5361 +++
5362 ** The new library bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
5363 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
5364 data structures.
5365
5366 ---
5367 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
5368 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
5369
5370 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
5371 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
5372 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
5373 commands.
5374
5375 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
5376 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
5377 SQL buffer.
5378
5379 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
5380 (function (lambda ()
5381 (master-mode t)
5382 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5383 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
5384 (function (lambda ()
5385 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5386
5387 +++
5388 ** The new library benchmark.el does timing measurements on Lisp code.
5389
5390 This includes measuring garbage collection time.
5391
5392 +++
5393 ** The new library testcover.el does test coverage checking.
5394
5395 This is so you can tell whether you've tested all paths in your Lisp
5396 code. It works with edebug.
5397
5398 The function `testcover-start' instruments all functions in a given
5399 file. Then test your code. The function `testcover-mark-all' adds
5400 overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to show where coverage
5401 is lacking. The command `testcover-next-mark' (bind it to a key!)
5402 will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
5403
5404 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
5405 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
5406 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
5407 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
5408 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
5409 value, such as (setq x 14).
5410
5411 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
5412 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
5413 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
5414 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
5415 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
5416 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
5417 \f
5418 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
5419
5420 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
5421 been added.
5422
5423 \f
5424 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
5425
5426 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
5427 with Custom.
5428
5429 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
5430 as mule-utf-8.
5431
5432 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
5433 in UTF-8 locales).
5434
5435 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
5436 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
5437 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
5438 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
5439 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
5440 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
5441 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
5442 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
5443 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
5444 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
5445
5446 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
5447 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
5448
5449 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
5450 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
5451 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
5452 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
5453 contrary to the compound text specification.
5454
5455 \f
5456 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
5457
5458 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
5459
5460 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
5461
5462 \f
5463 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
5464
5465 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
5466
5467 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
5468 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
5469 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
5470 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
5471 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
5472
5473 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
5474 were changed.
5475
5476 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
5477 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
5478
5479 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
5480 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
5481 instead of using default-major-mode.
5482
5483 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
5484 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
5485 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
5486 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
5487 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
5488 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
5489 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
5490
5491 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
5492 NEWS.
5493
5494 \f
5495 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5496
5497 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5498 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5499 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5500
5501 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5502 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5503
5504 \f
5505 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5506
5507 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5508 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5509 charsets in this release.
5510
5511 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5512
5513 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5514
5515 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5516 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5517 to list them.
5518
5519 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5520 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5521 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5522 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5523 necessary changes to unexec.
5524
5525 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5526 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5527
5528 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5529 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5530
5531 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5532 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5533
5534 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5535 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5536 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5537 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5538 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5539
5540 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5541 new display features described below.
5542
5543 \f
5544 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5545
5546 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5547
5548 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5549 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5550 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5551 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5552 the text.
5553
5554 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5555
5556 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5557 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5558 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5559 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5560 specify a font.
5561
5562 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5563 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5564 under Lisp changes, below.
5565
5566 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5567
5568 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5569 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5570 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5571 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5572 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5573 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5574 on terminals.
5575
5576 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5577 supported on character terminals.
5578
5579 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5580 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5581 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5582 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5583
5584 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5585
5586 ** Sound support
5587
5588 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5589 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5590 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5591 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5592 sound support.
5593
5594 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5595
5596 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5597 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5598 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5599 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5600
5601 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5602
5603 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5604 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5605 specifies a number of lines.
5606
5607 Default is 0.25.
5608
5609 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5610
5611 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5612 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5613 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5614 again.
5615
5616 Default is `grow-only'.
5617
5618 ** LessTif support.
5619
5620 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5621 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5622
5623 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5624
5625 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5626 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5627 non-nil.
5628
5629 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5630
5631 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5632 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5633 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5634
5635 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5636
5637 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5638 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5639 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5640 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5641 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5642 Emacs.
5643
5644 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5645 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5646 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5647 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5648 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5649 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5650
5651 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5652 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5653 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5654 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5655 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5656 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5657
5658 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5659 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5660 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5661 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5662 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5663
5664 ** Tool bar support.
5665
5666 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5667 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5668 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5669 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5670 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5671 icons will be used.
5672
5673 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5674 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5675
5676 ** Tooltips.
5677
5678 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5679 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5680 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5681
5682 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5683 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5684 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5685 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5686
5687 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5688
5689 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5690 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5691 customized.
5692
5693 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5694 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5695 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5696 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5697 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5698
5699 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5700 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5701 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5702 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5703 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5704 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5705
5706 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5707 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5708 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5709 customizing face `fringe'.
5710
5711 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5712 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5713 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5714 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5715 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5716 the window to be partially obscured.)
5717
5718 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5719 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5720 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5721 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5722
5723 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5724
5725 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5726 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5727 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5728 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5729 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5730 have enabled one.
5731
5732 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5733
5734 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5735
5736 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5737
5738 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5739 `*') toggles the status.
5740
5741 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5742
5743 ** Hourglass pointer
5744
5745 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5746 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5747
5748 ** Blinking cursor
5749
5750 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5751 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5752 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5753 the group `cursor'.
5754
5755 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5756
5757 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5758 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5759 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5760 details.
5761
5762 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5763 have to do anything to activate it.
5764
5765 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5766
5767 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5768 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5769
5770 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5771 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5772 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5773 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5774 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5775 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5776 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5777 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5778
5779 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5780 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5781 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5782 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5783 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5784 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5785
5786 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5787 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5788
5789 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5790 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5791 buffer by default.
5792
5793 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5794 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5795 beginning and end of the buffer.
5796
5797 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5798 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5799 signaled.
5800
5801 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5802 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5803
5804 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5805 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5806 this behavior.
5807
5808 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5809 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5810 Emacs dump core.
5811
5812 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5813
5814 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5815 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5816 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5817
5818 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5819 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5820 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5821
5822 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5823 using that menu.
5824
5825 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5826
5827 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5828 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5829 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5830 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5831 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5832 whitespace.
5833
5834 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5835 all frames except the selected one.
5836
5837 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5838 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5839
5840 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5841 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5842 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5843 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5844 `Info-use-header-line'.
5845
5846 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5847 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5848 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5849
5850 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5851
5852 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5853 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5854 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5855
5856 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5857 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5858 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5859 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5860
5861 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5862
5863 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5864 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5865 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5866 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
5867
5868 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5869 point in a pop-up window.
5870
5871 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5872 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5873 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5874
5875 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5876 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5877
5878 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5879 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5880 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
5881 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
5882
5883 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
5884
5885 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5886 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5887
5888 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
5889 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
5890 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
5891
5892 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
5893 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
5894 non-nil.
5895
5896 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
5897 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
5898 file that is already visited under a different name.
5899
5900 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
5901 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5902
5903 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
5904 and displays information about that.
5905
5906 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5907 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5908
5909 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5910 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5911 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5912 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5913 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5914 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5915
5916 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
5917 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
5918
5919 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5920 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5921 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5922 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5923 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5924 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5925 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5926
5927 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5928 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5929
5930 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5931 system for keyboard input.
5932
5933 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5934 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5935 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5936 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5937 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
5938 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
5939 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
5940 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5941 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
5942
5943 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5944 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5945
5946 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5947 displays all characters in that character set.
5948
5949 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5950 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5951
5952 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5953 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5954 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5955
5956 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5957 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
5958 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5959 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
5960 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5961 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
5962 and Polish `slash'.
5963
5964 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
5965 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
5966 of the tutorial.
5967
5968 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
5969 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
5970 Lisp Coding Convention".
5971
5972 new command old-binding
5973 --- ------- -----------
5974 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
5975 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
5976 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
5977
5978 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
5979 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
5980 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
5981
5982 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
5983 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
5984 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
5985 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
5986 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
5987 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
5988
5989 ** There are new Leim input methods.
5990 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
5991 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
5992 package.
5993
5994 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
5995 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
5996 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
5997 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
5998 "`", you must type "=q".
5999
6000 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
6001 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
6002 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
6003 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
6004 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
6005 on.
6006
6007 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
6008 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
6009 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
6010 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
6011
6012 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
6013 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
6014 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
6015 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
6016
6017 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
6018 on the display using several methods
6019
6020 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
6021 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
6022 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
6023
6024 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
6025 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
6026
6027 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
6028
6029 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
6030 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
6031
6032 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
6033 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
6034 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
6035 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
6036
6037 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
6038 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
6039 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
6040
6041 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
6042 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
6043
6044 ** New X resources recognized
6045
6046 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
6047 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
6048 is useful for debugging X problems.
6049
6050 Example:
6051
6052 emacs.synchronous: true
6053
6054 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
6055 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
6056 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
6057 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
6058 visual class names are
6059
6060 TrueColor
6061 PseudoColor
6062 DirectColor
6063 StaticColor
6064 GrayScale
6065 StaticGray
6066
6067 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
6068 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
6069 meaning.
6070
6071 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
6072 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
6073 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
6074 visual.
6075
6076 Example:
6077
6078 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
6079
6080 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
6081 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
6082 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
6083 resource values are `true' or `on'.
6084
6085 Example:
6086
6087 emacs.privateColormap: true
6088
6089 ** Faces and frame parameters.
6090
6091 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
6092 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
6093 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
6094 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
6095 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
6096 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
6097 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
6098
6099 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
6100 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
6101 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
6102 `default' face and vice versa.
6103
6104 ** New face `menu'.
6105
6106 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
6107
6108 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
6109
6110 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
6111 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
6112 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
6113 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
6114
6115 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
6116 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
6117 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
6118
6119 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
6120 `ScreenGamma'.
6121
6122 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
6123
6124 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
6125 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
6126 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
6127 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
6128
6129 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
6130
6131 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
6132
6133 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
6134
6135 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
6136 LessTif/Motif one.
6137
6138 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
6139 LessTif and Motif.
6140
6141 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
6142
6143 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
6144 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
6145 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
6146
6147 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
6148 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
6149
6150 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
6151 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
6152 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
6153
6154 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
6155
6156 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
6157 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
6158 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6159 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
6160
6161 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
6162 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
6163 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6164 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
6165
6166 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
6167 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
6168 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
6169 buffers.
6170
6171 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
6172
6173 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
6174 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
6175 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
6176
6177 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
6178 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
6179 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
6180 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
6181 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
6182 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
6183
6184 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
6185
6186 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
6187 notably at the end of lines.
6188
6189 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
6190 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
6191
6192 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
6193
6194 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
6195 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
6196
6197 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
6198 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
6199 after each match to get the replacement text.
6200
6201 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
6202 you edit the replacement string.
6203
6204 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
6205 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
6206 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
6207
6208 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
6209
6210 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
6211 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
6212
6213 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
6214 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
6215 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
6216 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
6217
6218 --
6219 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
6220 read mail from the menu etc.
6221
6222 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
6223 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
6224 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
6225 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
6226
6227 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
6228 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6229
6230 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
6231 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
6232 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
6233 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
6234 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
6235 of Emacs.
6236
6237 ** Customize changes
6238
6239 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
6240 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
6241 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
6242 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
6243 earlier versions of Emacs.
6244
6245 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
6246 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
6247 default).
6248
6249 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6250 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
6251 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
6252 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
6253 file.
6254
6255 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6256 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
6257 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
6258 already in your init file.
6259
6260 ** New features in evaluation commands
6261
6262 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
6263 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
6264 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
6265 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
6266 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
6267
6268 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
6269 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
6270 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
6271 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
6272 printed).
6273
6274 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
6275 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
6276
6277 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
6278 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
6279
6280 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
6281 code when called with a prefix argument.
6282
6283 ** CC mode changes.
6284
6285 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
6286 current user setups (although it's believed that these
6287 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
6288 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
6289 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
6290 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
6291 release.
6292
6293 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
6294 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
6295 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
6296 confusion.
6297
6298 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
6299 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
6300 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
6301 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
6302
6303 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
6304 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
6305
6306 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
6307 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
6308
6309 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
6310 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
6311 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
6312 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
6313
6314 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
6315 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
6316 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
6317 earlier statement. An example:
6318
6319 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
6320 if (a[i])
6321 res += a[i]->offset;
6322 else
6323
6324 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
6325 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
6326 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
6327 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
6328 the preceding "if".
6329
6330 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
6331 by default.
6332
6333 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
6334 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
6335 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
6336 documentation or other natural language text.
6337
6338 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
6339 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
6340 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
6341 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
6342 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
6343 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
6344 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
6345
6346 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
6347 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
6348 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
6349 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
6350
6351 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
6352 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
6353 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
6354 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
6355 Pike mode only.
6356
6357 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
6358 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
6359 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
6360 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
6361 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
6362 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
6363 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
6364 is reported afterwards.
6365
6366 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
6367 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
6368 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
6369
6370 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
6371 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
6372 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
6373 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
6374 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
6375 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
6376 groundwork.
6377
6378 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
6379 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
6380 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
6381 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
6382 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
6383 have to bother.
6384
6385 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
6386 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
6387 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
6388 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
6389 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
6390 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
6391
6392 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
6393 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
6394 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
6395 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
6396 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
6397 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
6398 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
6399 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
6400
6401 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
6402 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
6403 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
6404 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
6405 above.
6406
6407 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
6408 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
6409 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
6410 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
6411 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
6412 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
6413 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
6414 function documentation for more info.
6415
6416 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
6417 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
6418 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
6419 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
6420 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
6421 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
6422 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
6423 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
6424
6425 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
6426
6427 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
6428 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
6429
6430 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
6431 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
6432 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
6433 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
6434 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
6435 style system.
6436
6437 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
6438 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
6439 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
6440 as far as possible.
6441
6442 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
6443 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
6444 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
6445 chapter about this in the manual.
6446
6447 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
6448 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
6449 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
6450 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
6451 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
6452
6453 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
6454 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
6455 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
6456
6457 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
6458 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
6459
6460 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
6461 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
6462 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
6463 inside CC Mode.
6464
6465 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
6466 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
6467 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
6468 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
6469 cc-mode/).
6470
6471 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
6472 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
6473 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
6474 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
6475 they were before the filling.
6476
6477 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
6478 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
6479 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
6480 literals.
6481
6482 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
6483 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
6484 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
6485 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
6486 this function.
6487
6488 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
6489 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
6490 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
6491 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
6492 Thanks to Eric Eide.
6493
6494 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6495 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6496 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6497
6498 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6499
6500 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6501 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6502 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6503 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6504
6505 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6506 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6507 the column specified by comment-column.
6508
6509 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6510 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6511 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6512 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6513 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6514 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6515
6516 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6517 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6518 arguments.
6519
6520 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6521
6522 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6523 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6524 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6525 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6526 Provan).
6527
6528 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6529
6530 ** Dired changes
6531
6532 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6533 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6534 is, delete only empty directories.
6535
6536 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6537 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6538 copy directories recursively.
6539
6540 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6541 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6542 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6543
6544 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6545 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6546 directory.
6547
6548 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6549 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6550 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6551 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6552 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6553
6554 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6555 from ls switches.
6556
6557 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6558 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6559 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6560 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6561
6562 ** Gnus changes.
6563
6564 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6565 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6566 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6567
6568 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6569 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6570
6571 If you used procmail like in
6572
6573 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6574 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6575 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6576 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6577
6578 this now has changed to
6579
6580 (setq mail-sources
6581 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6582 :suffix ".in")))
6583
6584 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6585 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6586
6587 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6588 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6589 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6590 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6591
6592 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6593 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6594 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6595
6596 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6597 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6598 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6599 now just a compatibility layer.
6600
6601 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6602 Gnus facilities.
6603
6604 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6605 called to position point.
6606
6607 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6608 summary buffers and NOV files.
6609
6610 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6611 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6612
6613 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6614 subtly different manner.
6615
6616 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6617 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6618 ever-changing layouts.
6619
6620 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6621
6622 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6623
6624 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6625
6626 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6627 macros
6628
6629 Key binding Macro
6630 -------------------------
6631 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6632 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6633 C-c C-c u @uref
6634 C-c C-c q @quotation
6635 C-c C-c m @email
6636 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6637 M-RET @item
6638
6639 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6640
6641 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6642
6643 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6644 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6645 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6646
6647 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6648
6649 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6650 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6651 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6652 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6653 buffers to kill, as before.
6654
6655 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6656 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6657 this way.
6658
6659 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6660 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6661
6662 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6663
6664 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6665 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6666 use. Default is 1000.
6667
6668 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6669 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6670
6671 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6672
6673 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6674
6675 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6676 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6677 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6678 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6679
6680 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6681 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6682 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6683 the open block.
6684
6685 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6686 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6687 the normal block-hiding function.
6688
6689 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6690
6691 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6692 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6693 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6694 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6695
6696 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6697 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6698
6699 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6700
6701 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6702 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6703 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6704
6705 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6706 current buffer.
6707
6708 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6709 in a log file.
6710
6711 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6712 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6713 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6714 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6715 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6716 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6717
6718 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6719
6720 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6721
6722 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6723 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6724
6725 ** Changes in Font Lock
6726
6727 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6728 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6729
6730 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6731 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6732
6733 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6734 the face used for each string/comment.
6735
6736 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6737 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6738
6739 ** Changes to Shell mode
6740
6741 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6742 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6743 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6744 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6745
6746 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6747
6748 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6749 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6750
6751 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6752 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6753 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6754 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6755 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6756 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6757
6758 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6759 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6760 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6761 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6762 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6763 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6764 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6765 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6766
6767 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6768 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6769
6770 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6771 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6772 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6773
6774 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6775 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6776 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6777
6778 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6779 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6780 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6781
6782 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6783 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6784 argument, it appends to the file.
6785
6786 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6787 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6788 compatibility.
6789
6790 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6791 ring (history).
6792
6793 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6794 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6795 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6796
6797 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6798
6799 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6800 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6801 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6802 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6803 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6804 as correspondent.
6805
6806 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6807 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6808 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6809
6810 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6811 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6812 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6813 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6814 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6815
6816 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6817 like `j'.
6818
6819 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6820 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6821 digest message.
6822
6823 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6824 in which folder to put messages automatically.
6825
6826 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6827 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6828 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6829
6830 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6831 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6832
6833 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6834 use the -f option when sending mail.
6835
6836 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6837 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6838 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6839 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6840 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6841 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6842
6843 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6844 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6845 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6846
6847 ** Changes to TeX mode
6848
6849 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6850 `latex-mode'.
6851
6852 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6853
6854 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6855
6856 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6857
6858 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6859
6860 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6861 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6862 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6863 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6864 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6865 can be edited from that buffer.
6866
6867 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6868 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6869 `A' to use all marked entries).
6870
6871 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6872 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6873
6874 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6875 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6876 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6877 been cited.
6878
6879 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6880 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6881 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6882 in column 1 are always made leaves.
6883
6884 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
6885 has the following new features:
6886
6887 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
6888 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
6889 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
6890 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
6891
6892 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
6893 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
6894 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
6895 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
6896 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
6897 defaults to 1.
6898
6899 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
6900 file names.
6901
6902 ** Ispell changes
6903
6904 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6905 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6906 spell-checks the current buffer.
6907
6908 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6909 added.
6910
6911 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6912 correction is made and re-checked.
6913
6914 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
6915
6916 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6917 cases.
6918
6919 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6920 on syntax errors.
6921
6922 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6923 end of the buffer.
6924
6925 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6926
6927 ** Makefile mode changes
6928
6929 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
6930
6931 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6932 Fontlock mode is active.
6933
6934 ** Isearch changes
6935
6936 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6937 so that searches can be resumed.
6938
6939 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
6940 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6941 that started the search.
6942
6943 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6944 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6945
6946 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
6947
6948 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6949 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6950 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6951 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6952 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6953 `secondary-selection'.
6954
6955 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6956 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6957 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6958 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6959 usual snappy response.
6960
6961 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
6962 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
6963 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
6964 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
6965
6966 ** VC Changes
6967
6968 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
6969 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
6970 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
6971 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
6972 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
6973 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
6974 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
6975 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
6976 file is registered in that backend.
6977
6978 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
6979 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
6980 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
6981 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
6982 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
6983 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
6984
6985 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
6986 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
6987 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
6988 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
6989 where it doesn't make sense.)
6990
6991 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
6992 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
6993 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
6994
6995 *** General Changes
6996
6997 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
6998 checks are always done now.
6999
7000 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
7001 operations.
7002
7003 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
7004 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
7005 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
7006
7007 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
7008 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
7009 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
7010 the working file (``merge news'').
7011
7012 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7013 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
7014 downwards.
7015
7016 *** Multiple Backends
7017
7018 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
7019 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
7020 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
7021 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
7022 local RCS archives.
7023
7024 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
7025 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
7026 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
7027 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
7028
7029 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
7030 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
7031 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
7032 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
7033 current revision number from the more remote backend.
7034
7035 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
7036 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
7037 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
7038 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
7039
7040 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
7041 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
7042 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
7043 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
7044
7045 *** Changes for CVS
7046
7047 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
7048 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
7049 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
7050 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
7051 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
7052 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
7053 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
7054
7055 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
7056 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
7057 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
7058 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
7059 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
7060 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
7061 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
7062 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
7063 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
7064 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
7065 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
7066 name.)
7067
7068 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
7069 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
7070 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
7071 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
7072 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
7073 entire directory tree.
7074
7075 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
7076 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
7077 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
7078 "watched" by other developers.)
7079
7080 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7081 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
7082 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
7083 starting at the given directory.
7084
7085 *** Lisp Changes in VC
7086
7087 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
7088 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
7089 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
7090 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
7091 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
7092 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
7093 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
7094 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
7095 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
7096
7097 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
7098 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
7099 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
7100 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
7101
7102 ** New modes and packages
7103
7104 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
7105 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
7106 the default is not applicable.
7107
7108 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
7109 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
7110 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
7111
7112 Features are:
7113
7114 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
7115 drawn, like this: | \ /
7116 --+-- X
7117 | / \
7118
7119 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
7120 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
7121 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
7122 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
7123 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
7124 you are drawing.
7125
7126 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
7127 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
7128
7129 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
7130 flood-filling.
7131
7132 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
7133 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
7134 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
7135 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
7136
7137 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
7138 also do without the mouse.
7139
7140 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
7141 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
7142 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
7143 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
7144 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
7145
7146 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
7147
7148 lines straight-lines
7149 rectangles squares
7150 poly-lines straight poly-lines
7151 ellipses circles
7152 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
7153 spray-can setting size for spraying
7154 vaporize line vaporize lines
7155 erase characters erase rectangles
7156
7157 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
7158 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
7159 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
7160 drawing.
7161
7162 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
7163 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
7164 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
7165 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
7166
7167 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
7168 can be turned off).
7169
7170 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
7171 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
7172 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
7173 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
7174 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
7175 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
7176 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
7177 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
7178 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
7179
7180 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
7181 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
7182 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
7183 on certain projects.
7184
7185 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
7186 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
7187
7188 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
7189
7190 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
7191 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
7192 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
7193 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
7194 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
7195 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
7196 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
7197 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
7198
7199 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
7200 Emacs is idle.
7201
7202 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
7203 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
7204
7205 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
7206 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
7207
7208 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
7209 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
7210 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
7211 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
7212 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
7213
7214 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
7215 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
7216 separate Texinfo file.
7217
7218 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
7219 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
7220 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
7221 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
7222 enter check-in log messages.
7223
7224 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
7225 without invoking external programs.
7226
7227 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
7228 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
7229 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
7230 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
7231 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
7232
7233 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
7234 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
7235
7236 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
7237 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
7238
7239 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
7240 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
7241 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
7242 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
7243 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
7244 single step.
7245
7246 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
7247 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
7248 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
7249 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
7250
7251 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
7252 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
7253 actually modifying content of a buffer.
7254
7255 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
7256 PostScript.
7257
7258 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
7259
7260 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
7261
7262 ; comment (until end of line)
7263 A non-terminal
7264 "C" terminal
7265 ?C? special
7266 $A default non-terminal
7267 $"C" default terminal
7268 $?C? default special
7269 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
7270 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
7271 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
7272 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
7273 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
7274 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
7275 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
7276 C+ one or more occurrences of C
7277 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
7278 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
7279 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
7280 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
7281 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
7282 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7283 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7284
7285 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
7286
7287 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
7288 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
7289 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
7290 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
7291 equal signs of assignments.
7292
7293 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
7294 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
7295
7296 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
7297 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
7298 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
7299
7300 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
7301
7302 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
7303 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
7304 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
7305 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
7306 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
7307 which answers different needs.
7308
7309 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
7310 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
7311 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
7312 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
7313 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
7314 to be enabled.
7315
7316 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
7317 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
7318
7319 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
7320
7321 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
7322 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
7323 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
7324
7325 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
7326
7327 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
7328 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
7329 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
7330 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
7331 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
7332 and background colors.
7333
7334 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
7335 Pascal) language.
7336
7337 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
7338 the text at point.
7339
7340 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
7341
7342 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
7343
7344 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
7345 whitespace in a file.
7346
7347 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
7348 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
7349 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
7350 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
7351 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
7352 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
7353 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
7354
7355 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
7356
7357 Here is an example of columns:
7358
7359 horse apple bus
7360 dog pineapple car EXTRA
7361 porcupine strawberry airplane
7362
7363 Doing the following settings:
7364
7365 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
7366 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
7367 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
7368 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
7369
7370
7371 Selecting the lines above and typing:
7372
7373 M-x delimit-columns-region
7374
7375 It results:
7376
7377 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
7378 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
7379 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
7380
7381 delim-col has the following options:
7382
7383 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
7384 before all columns.
7385
7386 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
7387 between each column.
7388
7389 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
7390 after all columns.
7391
7392 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
7393 each column.
7394
7395 delim-col has the following commands:
7396
7397 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
7398 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
7399
7400 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
7401 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
7402 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
7403 recent file list can be displayed:
7404
7405 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
7406 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
7407 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
7408
7409 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
7410 dynamically change the menu appearance.
7411
7412 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
7413 text.
7414
7415 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
7416 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
7417 specific to Message mode.
7418
7419 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
7420 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
7421 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
7422
7423 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
7424 interface to access directory servers using different directory
7425 protocols. It has a separate manual.
7426
7427 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
7428 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
7429
7430 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
7431
7432 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
7433 minibuffer with completion.
7434
7435 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
7436 with the diary features.
7437
7438 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
7439 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
7440
7441 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
7442 Fill mode.
7443
7444 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
7445 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
7446 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
7447 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
7448
7449 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
7450 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
7451 `.g'.
7452
7453 ** Changes in sort.el
7454
7455 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
7456 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
7457 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
7458 numeric base.
7459
7460 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
7461
7462 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
7463 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
7464 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
7465
7466 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
7467 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
7468
7469 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
7470 output ^M at the end of lines.
7471
7472 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
7473 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
7474
7475 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
7476 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
7477 `(msb-mode 1)'.
7478
7479 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
7480 group.
7481
7482 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
7483 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
7484 are recognized:
7485
7486 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
7487 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
7488 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
7489 nil -- just delete one character.
7490
7491 Default value is `untabify'.
7492
7493 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7494
7495 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7496 symbol, not double-quoted.
7497
7498 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7499 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7500 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7501 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7502
7503 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7504 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7505 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7506
7507 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7508 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7509 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7510
7511 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7512 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7513
7514 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7515 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7516
7517 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7518 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7519
7520 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7521 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7522 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7523 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7524 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7525 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7526
7527 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7528 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7529
7530 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7531
7532 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7533 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7534
7535 ** Shell script mode changes.
7536
7537 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7538 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7539 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7540
7541 ** Etags changes.
7542
7543 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7544
7545 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7546 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7547 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7548 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7549 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7550
7551 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7552 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7553
7554 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7555 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7556
7557 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7558 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7559 `template' keywords.
7560
7561 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7562 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7563
7564 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7565 types.
7566
7567 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7568
7569 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7570
7571 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7572 are now tagged.
7573
7574 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7575
7576 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7577 variables are tagged.
7578
7579 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7580
7581 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7582 for PSWrap.
7583
7584 ** Changes in etags.el
7585
7586 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7587 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7588 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7589
7590 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7591 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7592
7593 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7594 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7595 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7596 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7597
7598 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7599
7600 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7601 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7602
7603 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7604
7605 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7606 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7607 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7608
7609 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7610 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7611
7612 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7613 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7614
7615 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7616 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7617 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7618 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7619 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7620
7621 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7622 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7623 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7624
7625 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7626 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7627 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7628
7629 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7630 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7631 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7632
7633 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7634
7635 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7636
7637 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7638 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7639 expression from that list, are not checked.
7640
7641 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7642 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7643 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7644 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7645
7646 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7647
7648 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7649 displays local abbrevs, only.
7650
7651 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7652 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7653
7654 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7655 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7656 is measured in pixels.
7657
7658 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7659 to be visited as images.
7660
7661 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7662 were added to compile.el.
7663
7664 ** Withdrawn packages
7665
7666 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7667 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7668
7669 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7670
7671 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7672
7673 \f
7674 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7675
7676 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7677 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7678 See the sections below for details.
7679
7680 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7681 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7682 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7683 to remove the properties of the copy.
7684
7685 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7686 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7687 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7688 these properties are active.
7689
7690 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7691 ranges may affect some code.
7692
7693 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7694 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7695 make a difference to some code.
7696
7697 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7698 operates on the minibuffer.
7699
7700 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7701 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7702 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7703 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7704 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7705 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7706 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7707 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7708 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7709 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7710 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7711 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7712
7713 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7714 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7715 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7716
7717 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7718 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7719 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7720
7721 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7722 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7723 such as `mapconcat'.
7724
7725 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7726 string.
7727
7728 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7729 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7730 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7731 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7732 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7733 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7734 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7735 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7736
7737 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7738 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7739 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7740 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7741 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7742 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7743 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7744 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7745 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7746 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7747
7748 \f
7749 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7750 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7751
7752 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7753
7754 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7755 allows the animated display of strings.
7756
7757 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7758 interactive form of a function.
7759
7760 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7761 between custom options. Example:
7762
7763 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7764 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7765 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7766 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7767 :group 'mule
7768 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7769 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7770
7771 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7772 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7773 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7774
7775 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7776 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7777 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7778 (signal or normal termination).
7779
7780 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7781 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7782
7783 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7784 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7785
7786 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7787 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7788
7789 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7790
7791 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7792 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7793 being deleted.
7794
7795 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7796
7797 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7798 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7799 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7800 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7801 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7802 charset.
7803
7804 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7805 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7806 message.
7807
7808 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7809 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7810
7811 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7812 with the more general `:mask' property.
7813
7814 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
7815
7816 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7817 backslash.
7818
7819 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7820 is running in batch mode. For example,
7821
7822 (message "%s" (read t))
7823
7824 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7825 to standard output.
7826
7827 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7828 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7829
7830 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7831 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7832 frame or window.
7833
7834 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7835 were added
7836
7837 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7838
7839 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7840 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7841
7842 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7843
7844 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7845 comparison is done with `eq'.
7846
7847 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7848
7849 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7850 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7851 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7852
7853 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7854 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7855 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7856
7857 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7858 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7859
7860 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7861 function was declared obsolete.
7862
7863 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7864 retained as an alias).
7865
7866 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7867 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
7868
7869 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7870
7871 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7872
7873 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7874 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7875 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7876 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7877 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7878 means never include the minibuffer window.
7879
7880 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
7881
7882 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
7883
7884 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
7885
7886 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
7887 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
7888 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
7889 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
7890 returned.
7891
7892 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
7893 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
7894 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
7895 minibuffer even if it is active.
7896
7897 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
7898 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
7899 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
7900 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
7901 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7902 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7903
7904 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7905 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7906 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7907 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7908 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7909 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7910 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7911
7912 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7913 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7914 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
7915
7916 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7917 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
7918 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7919 Default value is nil.
7920
7921 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
7922 meaning no limit.
7923
7924 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7925 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7926 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7927
7928 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
7929 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7930 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7931
7932 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7933 list of a primitive.
7934
7935 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7936
7937 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7938 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7939 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7940 than replacing the local map.
7941
7942 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7943 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7944 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7945 instead.
7946
7947 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7948
7949 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7950 as promised long ago.
7951
7952 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
7953
7954 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7955 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7956 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7957
7958 \f
7959 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7960
7961 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
7962 regular expressions.
7963
7964 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
7965
7966 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7967
7968 - Macro: rx SEXP
7969
7970 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7971
7972 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
7973 notation.
7974
7975 STRING
7976 matches string STRING literally.
7977
7978 CHAR
7979 matches character CHAR literally.
7980
7981 `not-newline'
7982 matches any character except a newline.
7983 .
7984 `anything'
7985 matches any character
7986
7987 `(any SET)'
7988 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
7989 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
7990
7991 '(in SET)'
7992 like `any'.
7993
7994 `(not (any SET))'
7995 matches any character not in SET
7996
7997 `line-start'
7998 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
7999 in the text being matched
8000
8001 `line-end'
8002 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
8003
8004 `string-start'
8005 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8006 string being matched against.
8007
8008 `string-end'
8009 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8010 string being matched against.
8011
8012 `buffer-start'
8013 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8014 buffer being matched against.
8015
8016 `buffer-end'
8017 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8018 buffer being matched against.
8019
8020 `point'
8021 matches the empty string, but only at point.
8022
8023 `word-start'
8024 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8025 word.
8026
8027 `word-end'
8028 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
8029
8030 `word-boundary'
8031 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8032 word.
8033
8034 `(not word-boundary)'
8035 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
8036 word.
8037
8038 `digit'
8039 matches 0 through 9.
8040
8041 `control'
8042 matches ASCII control characters.
8043
8044 `hex-digit'
8045 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8046
8047 `blank'
8048 matches space and tab only.
8049
8050 `graphic'
8051 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8052 space, and DEL.
8053
8054 `printing'
8055 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8056 and DEL.
8057
8058 `alphanumeric'
8059 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8060 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8061
8062 `letter'
8063 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8064 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8065
8066 `ascii'
8067 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8068
8069 `nonascii'
8070 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8071
8072 `lower'
8073 matches anything lower-case.
8074
8075 `upper'
8076 matches anything upper-case.
8077
8078 `punctuation'
8079 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8080 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8081
8082 `space'
8083 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8084
8085 `word'
8086 matches anything that has word syntax.
8087
8088 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
8089 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
8090 of the following symbols.
8091
8092 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
8093 `punctuation' (\\s.)
8094 `word' (\\sw)
8095 `symbol' (\\s_)
8096 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
8097 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
8098 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
8099 `string-quote' (\\s\")
8100 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
8101 `escape' (\\s\\)
8102 `character-quote' (\\s/)
8103 `comment-start' (\\s<)
8104 `comment-end' (\\s>)
8105
8106 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
8107 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
8108
8109 `(category CATEGORY)'
8110 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
8111 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
8112
8113 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
8114 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
8115 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
8116 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
8117 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
8118 `symbol' (\\c5)
8119 `digit' (\\c6)
8120 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
8121 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
8122 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
8123 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
8124 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
8125 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
8126 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
8127 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
8128 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
8129 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
8130 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
8131 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
8132 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
8133 `ascii' (\\ca)
8134 `arabic' (\\cb)
8135 `chinese' (\\cc)
8136 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
8137 `greek' (\\cg)
8138 `korean' (\\ch)
8139 `indian' (\\ci)
8140 `japanese' (\\cj)
8141 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
8142 `latin' (\\cl)
8143 `lao' (\\co)
8144 `tibetan' (\\cq)
8145 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
8146 `thai' (\\ct)
8147 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
8148 `hebrew' (\\cw)
8149 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
8150 `can-break' (\\c|)
8151
8152 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
8153 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
8154
8155 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8156 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
8157
8158 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8159 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
8160 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
8161
8162 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8163 another name for `submatch'.
8164
8165 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8166 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
8167 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
8168 regular expression.
8169
8170 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
8171 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
8172 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
8173 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
8174 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
8175
8176 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
8177 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
8178
8179 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
8180 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8181
8182 `(0+ SEXP)'
8183 like `zero-or-more'.
8184
8185 `(* SEXP)'
8186 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8187
8188 `(*? SEXP)'
8189 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8190
8191 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
8192 matches one or more occurrences of A.
8193
8194 `(1+ SEXP)'
8195 like `one-or-more'.
8196
8197 `(+ SEXP)'
8198 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8199
8200 `(+? SEXP)'
8201 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8202
8203 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
8204 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
8205
8206 `(optional SEXP)'
8207 like `zero-or-one'.
8208
8209 `(? SEXP)'
8210 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8211
8212 `(?? SEXP)'
8213 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8214
8215 `(repeat N SEXP)'
8216 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8217
8218 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
8219 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8220
8221 `(eval FORM)'
8222 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
8223 `regexp-quote' it.
8224
8225 `(regexp REGEXP)'
8226 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
8227
8228 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
8229
8230 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
8231 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
8232 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
8233 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
8234
8235 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
8236 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
8237 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
8238 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
8239
8240 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
8241 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
8242 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
8243
8244 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
8245 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
8246 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
8247 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
8248 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
8249 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
8250 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
8251 eight-bit-graphic.
8252
8253 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
8254
8255 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
8256 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
8257 character set as previously.
8258
8259 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
8260 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
8261 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
8262
8263 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
8264 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
8265 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
8266 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
8267
8268 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
8269 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
8270
8271 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
8272 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
8273 "fontset-default".
8274
8275 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
8276 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
8277
8278 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
8279 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
8280 buffers and strings.
8281
8282 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
8283 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
8284 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
8285 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
8286 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
8287 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
8288 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
8289 also been deleted.
8290
8291 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
8292 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
8293 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
8294
8295 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
8296 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
8297 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
8298 may differ between buffer and string text.
8299
8300 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
8301 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
8302
8303 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
8304 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
8305 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
8306 `composition' from STRING.
8307
8308 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
8309 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
8310
8311 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
8312 obsolete.
8313
8314 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
8315 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
8316
8317 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
8318 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
8319 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
8320 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
8321
8322 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
8323 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
8324 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
8325 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
8326 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
8327 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
8328
8329 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
8330 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
8331 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
8332
8333 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
8334 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
8335 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
8336
8337 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
8338 have been introduced.
8339
8340 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
8341 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
8342 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
8343 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
8344 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
8345 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
8346 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
8347 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
8348 their multibyte equivalent.
8349
8350 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
8351 that offset in the file before writing.
8352
8353 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
8354 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
8355
8356 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
8357 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
8358 from which the command was issued.
8359
8360 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
8361 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
8362 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
8363 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
8364 operate on.
8365
8366 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
8367 to `window-buffer-height'.
8368
8369 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
8370
8371 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
8372 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
8373 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
8374
8375 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
8376 respectively.
8377
8378 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
8379 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
8380
8381 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
8382 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
8383 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
8384
8385 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
8386 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
8387 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
8388 is currently displayed in some window.
8389
8390 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
8391 argument function's results.
8392
8393 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
8394 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
8395 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
8396 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
8397 sequence).
8398
8399 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
8400 header in the list of headers passed to it.
8401
8402 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
8403 ignores differences in case and text representation.
8404
8405 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
8406 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
8407 as follows:
8408
8409 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
8410 nil don't display a cursor
8411 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
8412 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
8413 others display a box cursor.
8414
8415 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
8416 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
8417 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
8418 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
8419
8420 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
8421 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
8422 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
8423 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
8424
8425 Example:
8426
8427 (string-to-syntax "()")
8428 => (4 . 41)
8429
8430 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
8431 other than 10.
8432
8433 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
8434 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
8435
8436 #b1111
8437 => 15
8438 #b-1111
8439 => -15
8440
8441 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
8442
8443 #o666
8444 => 438
8445
8446 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
8447
8448 #xbeef
8449 => 48815
8450
8451 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
8452
8453 #2R-111
8454 => -7
8455 #25rah
8456 => 267
8457
8458 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
8459 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
8460 and isn't a string.
8461
8462 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
8463 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
8464 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
8465 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
8466
8467 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
8468
8469 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
8470 for a regexp in a string.
8471
8472 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
8473 `mouse-position-function'.
8474
8475 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
8476 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
8477
8478 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
8479 Keywords are now always considered constants.
8480
8481 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
8482 returns it.
8483
8484 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
8485 returned by function `recent-keys'.
8486
8487 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
8488 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
8489 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
8490 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
8491 mode.
8492
8493 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8494 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8495
8496 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8497 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8498 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8499 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8500 been performed."
8501
8502 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8503 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8504 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8505 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8506
8507 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8508 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8509 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8510
8511 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8512 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8513 specified table.
8514
8515 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8516
8517 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8518 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8519 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8520 what BODY returns.
8521
8522 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8523 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8524 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8525 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8526 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8527
8528 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8529 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8530
8531 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8532 instead of being optional.
8533
8534 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8535 modify read-only text.
8536
8537 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8538
8539 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8540 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8541 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8542 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8543 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8544
8545 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8546 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8547 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8548 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8549 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8550 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8551 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8552
8553 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8554 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8555 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8556 start sequences.
8557
8558 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8559 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8560
8561 ** New function `propertize'
8562
8563 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8564 strings with text properties.
8565
8566 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8567
8568 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8569 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8570 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8571 specified value of that property. Example:
8572
8573 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8574
8575 ** push and pop macros.
8576
8577 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8578 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8579 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8580
8581 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8582 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8583 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8584
8585 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8586
8587 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8588 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8589
8590 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8591 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8592 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8593 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8594
8595 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8596 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8597 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8598 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8599
8600 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8601 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8602 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8603 or a sign.
8604
8605 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8606 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8607 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8608 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8609 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8610 space, and DEL.
8611 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8612 and DEL.
8613 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8614 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8615 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8616 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8617 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8618 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8619 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8620 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8621 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8622 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8623 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8624 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8625 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8626 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8627 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8628
8629 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8630
8631 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8632
8633 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8634
8635 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8636 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8637
8638 :test TEST
8639
8640 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8641 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8642 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8643
8644 :size SIZE
8645
8646 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8647 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8648
8649 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8650
8651 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8652 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8653 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8654 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8655 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8656
8657 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8658
8659 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8660 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8661 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8662
8663 :weakness WEAK
8664
8665 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8666 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8667 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8668 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8669 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8670
8671 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8672
8673 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8674
8675 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8676
8677 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8678
8679 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8680
8681 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8682 values are shared.
8683
8684 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8685
8686 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8687
8688 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8689
8690 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8691
8692 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8693
8694 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8695
8696 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8697
8698 Returns the size of TABLE.
8699
8700 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8701
8702 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8703
8704 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8705
8706 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8707
8708 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8709
8710 Clear TABLE.
8711
8712 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8713
8714 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8715 not found.
8716
8717 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8718
8719 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8720 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8721
8722 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8723
8724 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8725
8726 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8727
8728 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8729 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8730
8731 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8732
8733 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8734
8735 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8736
8737 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8738 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8739 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8740 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8741 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8742
8743 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8744
8745 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8746 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8747 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8748
8749 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8750 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8751
8752 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8753 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8754
8755 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8756 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8757
8758 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8759 'case-fold-string-hash))
8760
8761 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8762
8763 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8764
8765 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8766 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8767 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8768
8769 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8770
8771 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8772 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8773
8774 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8775 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8776 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8777 is too short to reach that column.
8778
8779 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8780 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8781 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8782 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8783
8784 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8785 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8786 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8787
8788 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8789 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8790
8791 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8792 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8793
8794 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8795 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8796 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8797 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8798 temporary-file-directory instead.
8799
8800 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8801 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8802 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8803 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8804
8805 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8806 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8807
8808 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8809
8810 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8811 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8812 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8813
8814 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8815
8816 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8817 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8818 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8819 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8820 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8821 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8822
8823 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8824 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8825 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8826 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8827
8828 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8829
8830 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8831 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8832 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8833 result string.
8834
8835 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8836 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8837
8838 Example:
8839
8840 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8841 (s2 "world"))
8842 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8843 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8844 (format s1 s2))
8845
8846 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8847
8848 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8849
8850 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8851 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8852 argument in it.
8853
8854 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8855 (arg "world"))
8856 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8857 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8858 (message msg arg))
8859
8860 ** Sound support
8861
8862 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8863 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8864
8865 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8866 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8867 to enable sound support.
8868
8869 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8870 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8871 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8872 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8873 sound to play, before playing the sound.
8874
8875 The following sound properties are supported:
8876
8877 - `:file FILE'
8878
8879 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8880 searched relative to `data-directory'.
8881
8882 - `:data DATA'
8883
8884 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
8885 may be present, but not both.
8886
8887 - `:volume VOLUME'
8888
8889 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
8890 0..1. This property is optional.
8891
8892 - `:device DEVICE'
8893
8894 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
8895 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
8896
8897 Other properties are ignored.
8898
8899 An alternative interface is called as
8900 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
8901
8902 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
8903
8904 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8905 a keyword symbol.
8906
8907 ** Changes to garbage collection
8908
8909 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8910 of live and free strings.
8911
8912 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8913 strings that have been consed so far.
8914
8915 \f
8916 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8917 Lisp Manual
8918
8919 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8920 mini-windows.
8921
8922 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8923 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8924 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
8925
8926 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
8927
8928 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
8929
8930 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8931 image.
8932
8933 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8934
8935 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8936
8937 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8938 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8939 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8940 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8941 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8942
8943 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8944 has a mask bitmap.
8945
8946 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8947
8948 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8949 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8950 or omitted means use the selected frame.
8951
8952 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8953 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8954
8955 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8956 optional.
8957
8958 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8959 below).
8960
8961 \f
8962 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
8963
8964 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
8965 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
8966
8967 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
8968 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
8969 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
8970 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
8971 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
8972 just display it black instead.
8973
8974 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
8975 a line like
8976
8977 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
8978
8979 in your `.emacs'.
8980
8981 ** New face implementation.
8982
8983 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
8984 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
8985
8986 *** New faces.
8987
8988 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
8989
8990 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
8991
8992 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
8993 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
8994
8995 3. Font height in 1/10pt
8996
8997 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
8998
8999 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
9000
9001 6. Foreground color.
9002
9003 7. Background color.
9004
9005 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
9006
9007 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
9008
9009 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
9010
9011 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
9012
9013 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
9014 color.
9015
9016 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
9017 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
9018
9019 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
9020 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
9021 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
9022 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
9023 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
9024 attributes mentioned above.
9025
9026 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
9027 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
9028 created frames.
9029
9030 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
9031 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
9032 `fully-specified'.
9033
9034 *** Face merging.
9035
9036 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
9037 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
9038 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
9039 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
9040 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
9041 results in a fully-specified face.
9042
9043 *** Face realization.
9044
9045 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
9046 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
9047 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
9048 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
9049 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
9050 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
9051
9052 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
9053 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
9054 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
9055 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
9056
9057 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
9058 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
9059 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
9060 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
9061 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
9062
9063 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
9064 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
9065 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
9066 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
9067 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
9068 Emacs.
9069
9070 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
9071 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
9072 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
9073 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
9074
9075 **** Clearing face caches.
9076
9077 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
9078 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
9079 unused fonts.
9080
9081 *** Font selection.
9082
9083 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
9084 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
9085 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
9086
9087 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
9088 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
9089 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
9090 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
9091 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
9092
9093 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
9094 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
9095 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
9096
9097 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
9098
9099 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
9100 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
9101 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
9102 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
9103 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
9104 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
9105 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
9106
9107 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9108 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
9109 doesn't exist.
9110
9111 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9112 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
9113 registry.
9114
9115 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
9116 slightly different.
9117
9118 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
9119
9120
9121 **** Scalable fonts
9122
9123 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
9124 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
9125 servers.
9126
9127 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
9128 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
9129 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
9130 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
9131 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
9132 that list. Example:
9133
9134 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
9135
9136 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
9137
9138 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
9139
9140 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
9141
9142 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
9143 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
9144 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
9145
9146 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
9147 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
9148 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
9149 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
9150 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
9151 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
9152 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
9153 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
9154 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
9155 of the face font sort order.
9156
9157 - Function: x-font-family-list
9158
9159 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
9160 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
9161 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
9162 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
9163
9164 - Variable: font-list-limit
9165
9166 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
9167 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
9168 matching font. The default is currently 100.
9169
9170 *** Setting face attributes.
9171
9172 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
9173 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
9174 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
9175 `face-attribute'.
9176
9177 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
9178 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
9179
9180 The following attributes are recognized:
9181
9182 `:family'
9183
9184 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
9185 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
9186 and `?' are allowed.
9187
9188 `:width'
9189
9190 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
9191 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
9192 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
9193 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
9194
9195 `:height'
9196
9197 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
9198 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
9199 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
9200 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
9201
9202 `:weight'
9203
9204 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
9205 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
9206 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
9207
9208 `:slant'
9209
9210 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
9211 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
9212 `reverse-oblique'.
9213
9214 `:foreground', `:background'
9215
9216 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
9217
9218 `:underline'
9219
9220 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
9221 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
9222 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
9223 don't underline.
9224
9225 `:overline'
9226
9227 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
9228 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
9229 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
9230 overline.
9231
9232 `:strike-through'
9233
9234 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
9235 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
9236 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
9237 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
9238
9239 `:box'
9240
9241 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
9242 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
9243 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
9244 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
9245 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
9246 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
9247 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
9248 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
9249 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
9250 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
9251 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
9252 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
9253 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
9254 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
9255 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
9256 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
9257 box.
9258
9259 `:inverse-video'
9260
9261 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
9262 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
9263
9264 `:stipple'
9265
9266 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
9267 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
9268 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
9269 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
9270 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
9271 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
9272
9273 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
9274 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
9275
9276 `:font'
9277
9278 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
9279 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
9280 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
9281 versions of Emacs.
9282
9283 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
9284 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
9285 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
9286
9287 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
9288 `defface'.
9289
9290 `:inherit'
9291
9292 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
9293 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
9294 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
9295
9296 *** Face attributes and X resources
9297
9298 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
9299 from X resources:
9300
9301 Face attribute X resource class
9302 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
9303 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
9304 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
9305 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
9306 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
9307 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
9308 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
9309 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
9310 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
9311 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
9312 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
9313 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
9314 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
9315 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
9316 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
9317 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
9318 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9319 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
9320 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
9321 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9322
9323 *** Text property `face'.
9324
9325 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
9326 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
9327 specification can be
9328
9329 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
9330
9331 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
9332 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
9333 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
9334 for face attribute names.
9335
9336 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
9337 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
9338 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
9339
9340 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
9341
9342 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
9343 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
9344 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
9345 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
9346 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
9347 used to clear the mapping table.
9348
9349 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
9350
9351 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
9352 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
9353 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
9354 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
9355 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
9356 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
9357 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
9358 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
9359 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
9360 modify their color-related behavior.
9361
9362 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
9363 any frame type.
9364
9365 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
9366
9367 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
9368 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
9369 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
9370 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
9371 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
9372 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
9373 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
9374 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
9375 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
9376
9377 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
9378 display can display image files.
9379
9380 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
9381
9382 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
9383 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
9384 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
9385 `Inviolable' option.
9386
9387 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
9388 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
9389 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
9390
9391 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
9392
9393 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
9394 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
9395 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
9396
9397 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
9398 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9399 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
9400 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
9401 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
9402 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
9403 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
9404 functions.
9405
9406 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9407 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
9408 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
9409
9410 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
9411
9412 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9413
9414 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
9415
9416 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9417 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9418 constrained position if that is different.
9419
9420 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
9421 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
9422 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
9423 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9424 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9425 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
9426 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
9427 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
9428 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9429
9430 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
9431 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
9432 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
9433 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
9434 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
9435
9436 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
9437 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
9438
9439 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
9440
9441 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
9442
9443 Delete the field surrounding POS.
9444 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9445 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9446
9447 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9448
9449 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
9450 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9451 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9452 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9453 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
9454
9455 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9456
9457 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
9458 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9459 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9460 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9461 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
9462
9463 - Function: field-string &optional POS
9464
9465 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
9466 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9467 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9468
9469 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
9470
9471 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
9472 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9473 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9474
9475 ** Image support.
9476
9477 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
9478 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
9479 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
9480 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
9481
9482 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
9483 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
9484 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
9485 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
9486 area.
9487
9488 IMAGE is an image specification.
9489
9490 *** Image specifications
9491
9492 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
9493 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9494 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9495 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9496 described below are ignored.
9497
9498 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9499
9500 `:ascent ASCENT'
9501
9502 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9503 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9504 to use for its ascent.
9505
9506 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9507 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9508
9509 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9510 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9511 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9512 overlays that apply to the image.
9513
9514 `:margin MARGIN'
9515
9516 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9517 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9518 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9519
9520 `:relief RELIEF'
9521
9522 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9523 around an image.
9524
9525 `:conversion ALGO'
9526
9527 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9528
9529 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9530 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9531
9532 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9533 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9534 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9535 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9536 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9537 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9538 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9539 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9540 below.
9541
9542 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9543 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9544 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9545
9546 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9547 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9548 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9549 of the factors' absolute values.
9550
9551 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9552
9553 (1 0 0
9554 0 0 0
9555 9 9 -1)
9556
9557 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9558
9559 ( 2 -1 0
9560 -1 0 1
9561 0 1 -2)
9562
9563 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9564 ``disabled''.
9565
9566 `:mask MASK'
9567
9568 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9569 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9570 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9571 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9572 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9573 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9574 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9575 image.
9576
9577 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9578 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9579 `:mask nil'.
9580
9581 `:file FILE'
9582
9583 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9584 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9585 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9586 may be present in the image specification.
9587
9588 `:data DATA'
9589
9590 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9591 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9592 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9593 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9594
9595 *** Supported image types
9596
9597 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9598
9599 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9600 properties supported are:
9601
9602 `:foreground FG'
9603
9604 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9605 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9606
9607 `:background BG'
9608
9609 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9610 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9611
9612 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9613 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9614 instead of a `:file' property.
9615
9616 `:width WIDTH'
9617
9618 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9619
9620 `:height HEIGHT'
9621
9622 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9623
9624 `:data DATA'
9625
9626 DATA must be either
9627
9628 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9629 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9630
9631 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9632
9633 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9634 bitmap.
9635
9636 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9637 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9638 in the file.
9639
9640 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9641
9642 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9643 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9644 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9645 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9646
9647 Additional image properties supported are:
9648
9649 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9650
9651 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9652 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9653 name.
9654
9655 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9656 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9657
9658 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9659 to display compressed images.
9660
9661 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9662
9663 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9664 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9665 mono images are:
9666
9667 `:foreground FG'
9668
9669 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9670 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9671
9672 `:background FG'
9673
9674 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9675 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9676
9677 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9678
9679 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9680 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9681 properties defined.
9682
9683 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9684
9685 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9686 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9687 properties defined.
9688
9689 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9690
9691 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9692 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9693
9694 Additional image properties supported are:
9695
9696 `:index INDEX'
9697
9698 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9699 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9700 as a hollow box.
9701
9702 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9703 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9704 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9705 every 0.1 seconds.
9706
9707 (defun show-anim (file max)
9708 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9709 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9710
9711 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9712 (when (= idx max)
9713 (setq idx 0))
9714 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9715 (save-excursion
9716 (set-buffer buffer)
9717 (goto-char (point-min))
9718 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9719 (insert-image img "x"))
9720 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9721
9722 **** PNG, image type `png'
9723
9724 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9725 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9726 properties defined.
9727
9728 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9729
9730 Additional image properties supported are:
9731
9732 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9733
9734 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9735 integer. This is a required property.
9736
9737 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9738
9739 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9740 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9741
9742 `:bounding-box BOX'
9743
9744 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9745 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9746 files. This is an required property.
9747
9748 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9749 lisp/gs.el.
9750
9751 *** Lisp interface.
9752
9753 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9754 which are supported in the current configuration.
9755
9756 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9757 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9758 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9759 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9760 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9761
9762 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9763
9764 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9765 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9766 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9767 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9768 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9769 buffer.
9770
9771 ** Display margins.
9772
9773 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9774 and images.
9775
9776 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9777 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9778 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9779 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9780 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9781 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9782 of the display margins.
9783
9784 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9785 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9786 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9787 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9788 in this file).
9789
9790 ** Help display
9791
9792 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9793 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9794 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9795 that have a `help-echo' property.
9796
9797 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9798 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9799 the window in which the help was found.
9800
9801 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9802 `help-echo' text property was found.
9803
9804 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9805 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9806
9807 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9808 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9809 mouse.
9810
9811 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9812 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9813
9814 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9815 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9816 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9817 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9818 used as help string.
9819
9820 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
9821 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9822 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
9823
9824 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9825
9826 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9827 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9828
9829 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9830 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9831 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9832 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9833 used.
9834
9835 (global-set-key [A-down]
9836 #'(lambda ()
9837 (interactive)
9838 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9839 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9840 (global-set-key [A-up]
9841 #'(lambda ()
9842 (interactive)
9843 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9844 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9845
9846 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9847
9848 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9849 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9850 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9851 is called with one argument, POS.
9852
9853 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9854 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9855 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9856 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9857 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9858
9859 ** Tool bar support.
9860
9861 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9862 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9863 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9864 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9865 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9866 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9867
9868 *** Tool bar item definitions
9869
9870 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9871 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9872 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
9873
9874 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9875 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9876 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9877 property (see below).
9878
9879 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9880 binding are currently ignored.
9881
9882 The following properties are recognized:
9883
9884 `:enable FORM'.
9885
9886 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
9887 or disabled.
9888
9889 `:visible FORM'
9890
9891 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
9892
9893 `:filter FUNCTION'
9894
9895 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
9896 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
9897 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
9898
9899 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
9900
9901 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9902 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
9903
9904 `:image IMAGES'
9905
9906 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9907 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9908 meaning of each of the four elements:
9909
9910 Index Use when item is
9911 ----------------------------------------
9912 0 enabled and selected
9913 1 enabled and deselected
9914 2 disabled and selected
9915 3 disabled and deselected
9916
9917 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9918 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9919
9920 `:help HELP-STRING'.
9921
9922 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9923 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9924
9925 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
9926 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9927 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9928 menu bar.
9929
9930 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9931 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9932 buffer-locally to override the global map.
9933
9934 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
9935
9936 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9937 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9938 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9939
9940 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
9941 raised when the mouse moves over them.
9942
9943 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9944 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
9945 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9946 vertical margins . Default is 1.
9947
9948 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9949 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9950
9951 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9952
9953 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
9954 a tool bar item. If
9955
9956 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9957 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9958 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9959
9960 is the original tool bar item definition, then
9961
9962 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
9963
9964 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
9965 item.
9966
9967 ** Mode line changes.
9968
9969 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
9970
9971 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
9972 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
9973 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
9974
9975 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
9976 a `local-map' text property.
9977
9978 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
9979 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
9980
9981 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
9982 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
9983 `local-map' property.
9984
9985 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
9986 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
9987 example.
9988
9989 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
9990 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
9991
9992 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
9993 variable mode-line-format to nil.
9994
9995 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
9996
9997 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
9998 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
9999 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
10000 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
10001 line.
10002
10003 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
10004 `header-line'.
10005
10006 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
10007 position in the header-line.
10008
10009 ** Text property `display'
10010
10011 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
10012 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
10013 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
10014 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
10015 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
10016
10017 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
10018
10019 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
10020 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
10021
10022 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
10023 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
10024 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
10025 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10026 simpler form STRING as property value.
10027
10028 *** Variable width and height spaces
10029
10030 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
10031 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
10032 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
10033 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
10034 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
10035 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10036 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
10037
10038 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
10039 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
10040 properties described below.
10041
10042 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
10043 characters having the `display' property.
10044
10045 - :width WIDTH
10046
10047 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
10048 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
10049
10050 - :relative-width FACTOR
10051
10052 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
10053 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
10054 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
10055 width of that character by FACTOR.
10056
10057 - :align-to HPOS
10058
10059 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
10060 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
10061
10062 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
10063
10064 - :height HEIGHT
10065
10066 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
10067 normal line height.
10068
10069 - :relative-height FACTOR
10070
10071 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
10072 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
10073
10074 - :ascent ASCENT
10075
10076 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
10077 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
10078 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
10079 equal to 100.
10080
10081 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
10082
10083 *** Images
10084
10085 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
10086 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
10087 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
10088 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
10089 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
10090 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
10091 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
10092 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
10093 as display specification.
10094
10095 *** Other display properties
10096
10097 - (space-width FACTOR)
10098
10099 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
10100 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
10101 integer or float.
10102
10103 - (height HEIGHT)
10104
10105 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
10106
10107 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
10108 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
10109 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
10110 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
10111 a font is available counts as a step.
10112
10113 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
10114 as tall as the frame's default font.
10115
10116 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
10117 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
10118
10119 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
10120 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
10121
10122 - (raise FACTOR)
10123
10124 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
10125 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
10126 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
10127 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
10128 `height' subproperty.
10129
10130 *** Conditional display properties
10131
10132 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
10133 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
10134 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
10135 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
10136 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
10137 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
10138 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
10139 different when object is a string.
10140
10141 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
10142 `(when t . SPEC)'.
10143
10144 ** New menu separator types.
10145
10146 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
10147 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
10148 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
10149 to specify other menu separator types.
10150
10151 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
10152
10153 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
10154 separator occurs.
10155
10156 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
10157
10158 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
10159
10160 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
10161
10162 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
10163
10164 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
10165
10166 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10167
10168 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
10169
10170 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10171
10172 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
10173
10174 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
10175 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
10176
10177 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
10178
10179 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
10180
10181 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
10182
10183 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
10184
10185 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
10186
10187 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
10188
10189 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
10190
10191 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10192
10193 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
10194
10195 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
10196
10197 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
10198
10199 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10200
10201 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
10202
10203 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
10204
10205 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
10206 the corresponding single-line separators.
10207
10208 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
10209
10210 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
10211 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
10212 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
10213 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
10214 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
10215 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
10216 default foreground is black.
10217
10218 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
10219 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
10220 `ScrollBarBackground').
10221
10222 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
10223 settings for scroll bar colors.
10224
10225 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
10226 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
10227
10228 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
10229 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
10230 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
10231 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
10232 the original window start.
10233
10234 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
10235 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
10236 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
10237
10238 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
10239
10240 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
10241 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
10242 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
10243 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
10244
10245 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
10246 fixed-width and fixed-height.
10247
10248 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
10249
10250 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
10251 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
10252 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
10253 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
10254 temporarily to nil, for example
10255
10256 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
10257 (enlarge-window 10))
10258
10259 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
10260 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
10261
10262 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
10263 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
10264 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
10265 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
10266 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
10267 support a vertical-bar cursor).
10268
10269
10270 \f
10271 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
10272
10273 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
10274 input.
10275
10276 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
10277
10278 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
10279
10280 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
10281 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
10282 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
10283 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
10284 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
10285
10286 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
10287 been added.
10288
10289 \f
10290 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
10291
10292 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
10293
10294
10295 \f
10296 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
10297
10298 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
10299 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
10300 \f
10301 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
10302
10303 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
10304
10305 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
10306 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
10307 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
10308
10309 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
10310 is the one that is used.
10311
10312 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
10313 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
10314 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
10315 separate from the command's regular output.
10316 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
10317 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
10318 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
10319 the buffer name.
10320
10321 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
10322 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
10323 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
10324 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
10325
10326 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
10327 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
10328 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
10329 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
10330
10331 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
10332 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
10333 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
10334 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
10335
10336 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
10337 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
10338 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
10339 they never ignore case.
10340
10341 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
10342 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
10343 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
10344 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
10345 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
10346 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
10347 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
10348
10349 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
10350 the same format that was used in the file before.
10351
10352 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
10353 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
10354
10355 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
10356 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
10357 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
10358
10359 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
10360 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
10361 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
10362 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
10363 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
10364 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
10365 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
10366
10367 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
10368 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
10369 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
10370 format. You can now customize these variables.
10371
10372 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
10373 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
10374 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
10375 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
10376
10377 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
10378 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
10379 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
10380
10381 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
10382 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
10383 doesn't have any effect.
10384
10385 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
10386 not one per buffer.
10387
10388 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
10389 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
10390 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
10391
10392 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
10393 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
10394 `auto-show-mode' command.
10395
10396 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
10397 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
10398 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
10399 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
10400 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
10401
10402 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
10403 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
10404
10405 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
10406 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
10407 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
10408
10409 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
10410 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
10411 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
10412 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
10413
10414 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
10415
10416 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
10417 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
10418 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
10419 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
10420 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
10421
10422 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
10423 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
10424
10425 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
10426 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
10427 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
10428 `?' on other systems.
10429
10430 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
10431 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
10432 Unix.
10433
10434 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
10435 current codepage when it starts.
10436
10437 ** Mail changes
10438
10439 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
10440 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
10441 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
10442 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
10443 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
10444 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
10445 latin-1:
10446
10447 MIME-version: 1.0
10448 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
10449 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
10450
10451 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
10452 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
10453 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
10454 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
10455 buffer-file-coding-system.
10456
10457 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
10458 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
10459 mail.
10460
10461 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
10462 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
10463 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
10464 list of possible coding systems.
10465
10466 ** CC Mode changes
10467
10468 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
10469 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
10470 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
10471 docstring for details.
10472
10473 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
10474 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
10475 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
10476 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
10477 lineup functions use this feature currently.
10478
10479 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
10480 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
10481
10482 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
10483 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
10484
10485 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
10486 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
10487 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
10488 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
10489 anonymous classes.
10490
10491 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
10492 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
10493
10494 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10495 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10496 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10497 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10498
10499 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10500 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10501 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10502 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10503 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10504
10505 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10506
10507 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10508
10509 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10510 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10511
10512 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10513
10514 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10515 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10516 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10517 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10518 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10519
10520 ** Gnus changes.
10521
10522 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10523 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10524 Gnus manual for the full story.
10525
10526 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10527 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10528 group, which is created automatically.
10529
10530 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10531 values.
10532
10533 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10534
10535 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10536 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10537
10538 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10539 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10540
10541 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10542
10543 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10544 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10545
10546 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10547
10548 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10549 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10550
10551 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10552 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10553
10554 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10555 control over simplification.
10556
10557 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10558
10559 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10560 limit.
10561
10562 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10563
10564 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10565
10566 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10567 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10568 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10569
10570 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10571 `a' forces normal posting method.
10572
10573 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10574 -- `W d'.
10575
10576 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10577 to a non-nil value.
10578
10579 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10580 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10581
10582 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10583 has been added.
10584
10585 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10586
10587 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10588
10589 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10590 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10591
10592 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10593 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10594
10595 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10596
10597 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10598 been added.
10599
10600 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10601 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10602
10603 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10604 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10605
10606 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10607
10608 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10609
10610 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10611
10612 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10613
10614 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10615 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10616 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10617
10618 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10619 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10620 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10621 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10622 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10623
10624 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10625 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10626 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10627 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10628
10629 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10630 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10631 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10632 mismatch.
10633
10634 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10635
10636 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10637 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10638
10639 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10640 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10641 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10642 removed from the label.
10643
10644 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10645 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10646
10647 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10648 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10649
10650 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10651 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10652 expressions.
10653
10654 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10655
10656 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10657
10658 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10659 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10660
10661 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10662 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10663 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10664
10665 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
10666 changes with a special face.
10667
10668 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10669 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10670 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10671 \f
10672 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10673
10674 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10675 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10676 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10677 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10678 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10679
10680 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10681 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10682 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10683
10684 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10685 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10686 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10687 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10688 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10689 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10690 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10691 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10692 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10693
10694 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10695 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10696 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10697 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10698 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10699 program.
10700
10701 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10702 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10703 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10704 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10705 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10706 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10707
10708 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10709 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10710 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10711 was not documented clearly before.
10712
10713 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10714 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10715 \f
10716 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10717
10718 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10719 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10720 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10721 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10722
10723 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10724 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10725 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10726
10727 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10728
10729 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10730 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10731
10732 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10733 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10734 integers.
10735
10736 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10737 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10738 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10739 file names and attributes are returned.
10740
10741 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10742 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10743 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10744 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10745 returns the result.
10746
10747 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10748 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10749
10750 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10751
10752 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10753 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10754 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10755 optionally.
10756
10757 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10758 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10759
10760 **
10761 The new function process-running-child-p
10762 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10763 terminal to its own child process.
10764
10765 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10766 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10767 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10768 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10769
10770 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10771 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10772
10773 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10774 :included is an alias for :visible.
10775
10776 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10777 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10778 to move or copy menu entries.
10779
10780 ** Multibyte editing changes
10781
10782 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10783 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10784 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10785 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10786 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10787 (setq char (sref str idx)
10788 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10789 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10790
10791 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10792 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10793 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10794
10795 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10796 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10797 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10798
10799 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10800
10801 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10802 across the boundary.
10803
10804 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10805 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10806 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10807 contains 8-bit characters.
10808 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10809 contains invalid characters.
10810
10811 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10812 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10813 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10814 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10815 way.
10816
10817 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10818 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10819 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10820 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10821
10822 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10823 compose Thai characters in a string.
10824
10825 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10826 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10827 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10828 menus should always use the third argument.
10829
10830 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10831 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10832 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10833 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10834
10835 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10836 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10837 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10838 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10839
10840 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10841 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10842 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10843 echo area contents.
10844
10845 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10846
10847 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10848 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10849 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10850
10851 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10852 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10853 means to clear out that attribute.
10854
10855 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10856 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10857
10858 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10859 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10860 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10861 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10862
10863 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10864 the gap of the current buffer.
10865
10866 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10867 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10868 current buffer.
10869
10870 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10871 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10872 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10873 it back in after any modifications have been made.
10874 \f
10875 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10876
10877 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10878 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10879 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10880 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10881 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10882
10883 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
10884 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
10885 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
10886 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
10887 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
10888
10889 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
10890 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
10891 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
10892
10893 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
10894 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
10895 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
10896 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
10897 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
10898 results.
10899
10900 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
10901 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10902 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10903 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
10904 \f
10905 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
10906
10907 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10908 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10909 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10910 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10911
10912 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10913 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10914 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10915 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10916 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10917 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10918 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10919 region.
10920
10921 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10922 selective undo.
10923
10924 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10925 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10926 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10927 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10928 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10929
10930 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10931 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10932 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10933 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10934
10935 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10936 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10937 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10938 something that most users not do.
10939
10940 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10941 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10942 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10943 applications.
10944
10945 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10946 pasting operations.
10947
10948 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10949 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10950 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10951 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10952 `ps-printer-name'.
10953
10954 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10955 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10956 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10957 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10958 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10959 hits a new word.
10960
10961 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
10962 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
10963 to be confused by TeX commands.
10964
10965 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
10966 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
10967 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
10968 of various alternative replacements and actions.
10969
10970 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
10971 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
10972 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
10973 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
10974 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
10975
10976 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
10977 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
10978
10979 ** Changes in input method usage.
10980
10981 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
10982 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
10983 respectively.
10984
10985 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
10986
10987 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
10988 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
10989
10990 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
10991 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
10992
10993 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
10994
10995 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
10996
10997 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
10998 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
10999
11000 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
11001 given in the following case:
11002 o When you are using a complex input method.
11003 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
11004
11005 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
11006 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
11007 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
11008 setting it to t is helpful.
11009
11010 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
11011
11012 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
11013 keys:
11014 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
11015 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
11016 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
11017 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
11018 environment.
11019
11020 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
11021 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
11022 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
11023 get
11024
11025 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
11026
11027 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
11028
11029 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
11030 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
11031
11032 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
11033 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
11034 its owner and group.
11035
11036 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
11037 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
11038
11039 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
11040 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
11041
11042 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
11043 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
11044 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
11045 by the left edge of the rectangle.
11046
11047 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
11048 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
11049 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
11050 for writing keyboard macros.
11051
11052 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
11053 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
11054 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
11055 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
11056 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
11057 info.
11058
11059 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
11060
11061 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
11062 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
11063 contents only.
11064
11065 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
11066 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
11067 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
11068 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
11069
11070 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
11071 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
11072 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
11073
11074 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
11075 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
11076 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
11077 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
11078
11079 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
11080 failure if the command produces no output.
11081
11082 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
11083 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
11084 the mouse.
11085
11086 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
11087 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
11088 function and variable names.
11089
11090 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
11091 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
11092 file-coding-system-alist.
11093
11094 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
11095 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
11096 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
11097 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
11098 according to the current fontset.
11099
11100 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
11101
11102 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
11103 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
11104 nonascii-insert-offset.
11105
11106 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
11107 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
11108 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
11109 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
11110
11111 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
11112 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
11113
11114 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
11115 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
11116
11117 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
11118 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
11119 command keys.
11120
11121 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
11122 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
11123
11124 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
11125 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
11126 all variables that have documentation.
11127
11128 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
11129 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
11130 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
11131 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
11132 it should show; the default is 20.
11133
11134 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
11135 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
11136 of your input.
11137
11138 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
11139 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
11140 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
11141 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
11142 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
11143 Newly added options are included as well.
11144
11145 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
11146 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
11147 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
11148
11149 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
11150 Customize menu.
11151
11152 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
11153 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
11154
11155 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
11156 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
11157 invoked.
11158
11159 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
11160 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
11161 The default is 1.
11162
11163 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
11164 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
11165 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
11166 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
11167 sensibly.
11168
11169 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
11170
11171 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
11172 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
11173 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
11174
11175 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
11176 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
11177 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
11178 every night.
11179
11180 ** Desktop changes
11181
11182 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
11183 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
11184
11185 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
11186 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
11187
11188 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
11189 read and post multi-lingual articles.
11190
11191 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
11192 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
11193 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
11194 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
11195 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
11196 made invisible again.
11197
11198 ** Mail reading and sending changes
11199
11200 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
11201 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
11202 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
11203 toggle.
11204
11205 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
11206 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
11207 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
11208 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
11209 rmail-default-body-file.
11210
11211 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
11212 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
11213 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
11214
11215 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
11216 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
11217 is evaluated to insert the signature.
11218
11219 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
11220 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
11221 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
11222 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
11223 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
11224 especially interested in trying feedmail.
11225
11226 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
11227 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
11228 provided by feedmail are:
11229
11230 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
11231 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
11232 there is also a queue for draft messages
11233
11234 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
11235 be prompted for confirmation
11236
11237 **** does smart filling of address headers
11238
11239 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
11240 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
11241 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
11242
11243 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
11244 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
11245 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
11246 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
11247
11248 ** Dired changes
11249
11250 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
11251 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
11252
11253 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
11254 run Dired on the directory name at point.
11255
11256 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
11257 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
11258 for a specified regexp.
11259
11260 ** VC Changes
11261
11262 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
11263 conveniently.
11264
11265 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
11266 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
11267 Dired.
11268
11269 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
11270 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
11271 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
11272 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
11273
11274 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
11275 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
11276 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
11277 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
11278 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
11279
11280 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
11281 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
11282 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
11283 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
11284 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
11285
11286 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
11287 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
11288 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
11289 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
11290
11291 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
11292 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
11293 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
11294
11295 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
11296 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
11297 session to resolve them.
11298
11299 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
11300 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
11301 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
11302 uses as well).
11303
11304 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
11305 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
11306 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
11307 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
11308 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
11309 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
11310 using ediff.
11311
11312 ** Changes in Font Lock
11313
11314 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
11315 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
11316 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
11317 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
11318 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
11319
11320 ** Frame name display changes
11321
11322 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
11323 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
11324 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
11325 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
11326
11327 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
11328 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
11329 menu.
11330
11331 ** Comint (subshell) changes
11332
11333 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
11334 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
11335 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
11336
11337 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
11338
11339 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
11340 that is, the line after the last line you got.
11341 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
11342
11343 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
11344 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
11345 the following line.
11346
11347 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
11348 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
11349 previously sent input.
11350
11351 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
11352 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
11353 as the search string.
11354
11355 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
11356 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
11357
11358 ** C mode changes
11359
11360 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
11361 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
11362 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
11363 definition.
11364
11365 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
11366 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
11367 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
11368 style is still the default however.
11369
11370 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
11371
11372 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
11373 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
11374 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
11375
11376 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
11377 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
11378
11379 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
11380 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
11381
11382 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
11383 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
11384
11385 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
11386 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
11387
11388 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
11389 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
11390 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
11391 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
11392
11393 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
11394
11395 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
11396 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
11397 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
11398
11399 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
11400 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
11401 expanding dynamically.
11402
11403 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
11404 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
11405
11406 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
11407 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
11408 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
11409 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
11410
11411 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
11412
11413 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
11414
11415 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
11416 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
11417 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
11418 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
11419 against the first word in the title.
11420
11421 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
11422 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
11423 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
11424 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
11425 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
11426 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
11427
11428 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
11429 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
11430 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
11431 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
11432
11433 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
11434
11435 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
11436 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
11437 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
11438 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
11439 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
11440 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
11441
11442 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
11443 Editing group once the package is loaded.
11444
11445 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
11446 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
11447 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
11448
11449 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
11450 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
11451
11452 ** Ispell changes.
11453
11454 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
11455 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
11456 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
11457
11458 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
11459 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
11460 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
11461 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
11462 include:
11463
11464 o URLs are automatically skipped
11465 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
11466
11467 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
11468
11469 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
11470
11471 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
11472 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
11473 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
11474 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
11475
11476 *** New recursive parser.
11477
11478 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
11479 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
11480 recursive parser scans the individual files.
11481
11482 *** Parsing only part of a document.
11483
11484 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
11485 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
11486 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
11487
11488 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
11489
11490 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
11491
11492 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
11493
11494 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11495
11496 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11497
11498 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11499 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11500
11501 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11502
11503 *** References to external documents.
11504
11505 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11506 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11507 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11508 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11509 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11510 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11511 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11512
11513 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11514
11515 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11516 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11517
11518 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11519 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11520
11521 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11522
11523 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11524 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11525
11526 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11527
11528 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11529 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11530 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11531 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11532 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11533 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11534 more.
11535
11536 *** Support for the varioref package
11537
11538 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11539
11540 *** New hooks
11541
11542 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11543 and citations are created. These hooks are
11544 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11545 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11546
11547 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11548
11549 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11550 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11551
11552 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11553
11554 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11555 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11556 fontified, use
11557
11558 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11559
11560 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11561 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11562 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11563 directories that contain the same file name.
11564
11565 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11566 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11567 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11568 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11569 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11570 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11571 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11572 directory.
11573
11574 ** New modes and packages
11575
11576 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11577 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11578 it, but some do not.
11579
11580 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11581 code.
11582
11583 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11584 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11585 around in a buffer.
11586
11587 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11588
11589 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11590 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11591 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11592 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11593
11594 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11595 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11596 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11597
11598 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11599 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11600 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
11601 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11602 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11603 the like.
11604
11605 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11606 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11607
11608 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11609 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11610 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11611 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11612
11613 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11614
11615 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11616 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11617 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11618 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11619 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
11620 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11621 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11622 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11623 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11624 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11625 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11626
11627 Platform-specific modes:
11628
11629 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11630 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11631 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11632 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11633 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11634 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11635 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11636 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11637 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11638 \f
11639 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11640
11641 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11642 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11643 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11644 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11645
11646 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11647 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11648 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11649
11650 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11651 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11652 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11653 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11654
11655 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11656 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11657 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11658 environment.
11659
11660 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11661 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11662 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11663 current input method for reading this one event.
11664
11665 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11666 now control whether to output certain characters as
11667 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11668 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11669 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11670 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11671 \f
11672 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11673
11674 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11675 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11676
11677 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11678 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11679 always increases point by 1.
11680
11681 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11682 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11683
11684 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11685
11686 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11687 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11688 default value changed. For example,
11689
11690 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11691 :type 'integer
11692 :group 'foo
11693 :version "20.3")
11694
11695 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11696 :version "20.3")
11697
11698 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11699 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11700 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11701 `:version' in the top level group.
11702
11703 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11704
11705 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11706 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11707
11708 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11709 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11710 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11711 to themselves.
11712
11713 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11714 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11715 values whatever.
11716
11717 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11718 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11719 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11720
11721 ** Frame-local variables.
11722
11723 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11724 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11725 local bindings for that variable.
11726
11727 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11728 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11729 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11730 parameter name.
11731
11732 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11733 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11734 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11735 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11736
11737 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11738 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11739 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11740 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11741
11742 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11743 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11744 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11745 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11746 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11747
11748 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11749 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11750 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11751 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11752
11753 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11754 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11755
11756 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11757 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11758 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11759
11760 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11761 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11762 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11763 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11764
11765 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11766 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11767 empty input.
11768
11769 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11770 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11771 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11772 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11773 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11774
11775 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11776 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11777 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11778 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11779
11780 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11781 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11782 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11783 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11784 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11785
11786 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11787 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11788 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11789 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11790
11791 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11792 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11793 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11794
11795 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11796 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11797 was directed to display this buffer.
11798
11799 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11800 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11801 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11802 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11803 set-window-configuration.
11804
11805 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11806 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11807 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11808 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11809
11810 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11811 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11812 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11813
11814 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11815 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11816 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11817
11818 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11819 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11820
11821 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11822 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11823
11824 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11825 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11826 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11827
11828 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11829 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11830 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11831 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11832
11833 ** Menu changes
11834
11835 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11836 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11837 better supported.
11838
11839 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11840 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11841 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11842 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11843 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11844
11845 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11846
11847 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11848 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11849 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11850 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11851
11852 The format is:
11853 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11854 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11855 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11856 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11857 The supported properties include
11858
11859 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11860 item is enabled.
11861 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11862 item should appear in the menu.
11863 :filter FILTER-FN
11864 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11865 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11866 It should return a binding to use instead.
11867 :keys DESCRIPTION
11868 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
11869 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
11870 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11871 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11872 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11873 keyboard binding.
11874 :key-sequence nil
11875 This means that the command normally has no
11876 keyboard equivalent.
11877 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11878 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11879 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11880 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11881 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11882
11883 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
11884 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
11885
11886 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
11887
11888 ** New event types
11889
11890 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
11891 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
11892 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
11893 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
11894
11895 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
11896
11897 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11898 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
11899 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
11900 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
11901 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11902 forward, away from the user.
11903
11904 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11905
11906 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11907 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11908 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11909 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11910 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11911
11912 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11913
11914 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11915 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11916 that were dragged and dropped.
11917
11918 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11919
11920 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11921
11922 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11923 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11924 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11925
11926 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11927 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11928 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11929
11930 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11931 in Emacs 19 and before.
11932
11933 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11934 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11935
11936 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11937 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11938 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11939 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11940
11941 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11942 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11943 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11944 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11945 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11946
11947 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11948 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11949 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11950 consistent with the new representation.
11951
11952 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11953 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11954 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11955 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11956
11957 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11958 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11959 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11960
11961 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
11962 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
11963 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11964
11965 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
11966 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
11967 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
11968
11969 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11970 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
11971
11972 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11973 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
11974
11975 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
11976 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
11977 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
11978 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
11979
11980 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
11981 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
11982
11983 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
11984 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
11985 buffer or string being searched.
11986
11987 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
11988 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
11989 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
11990 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
11991 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
11992 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
11993 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
11994
11995 *** Structure of coding system changed.
11996
11997 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
11998 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
11999 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
12000 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
12001 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
12002 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
12003 define-coding-system-alias.
12004
12005 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
12006 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
12007 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
12008 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
12009 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
12010 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
12011 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
12012 `iso-8859-1'.
12013
12014 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
12015 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
12016 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
12017 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
12018
12019 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
12020 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
12021 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
12022 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
12023
12024 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
12025 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
12026 This function requires a user interaction.
12027
12028 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
12029 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
12030 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
12031 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
12032 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
12033 select-safe-coding-system.
12034
12035 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
12036 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
12037 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
12038 was done.
12039
12040 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
12041 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
12042 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
12043
12044 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
12045 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
12046 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
12047 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
12048
12049 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
12050 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
12051 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
12052 converted.
12053
12054 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
12055 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
12056
12057 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
12058 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
12059 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
12060 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
12061 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
12062 range of characters.
12063
12064 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
12065 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
12066
12067 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
12068 in the current buffer at position POS.
12069
12070 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
12071 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
12072 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
12073 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
12074 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
12075 binding input-method-function to nil.
12076
12077 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
12078 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
12079 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
12080 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
12081 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
12082
12083 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
12084 subsequent events of a key sequence.
12085
12086 *** You can customize any language environment by using
12087 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
12088
12089 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
12090 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
12091 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
12092 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
12093 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
12094 \f
12095 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
12096
12097 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
12098 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
12099 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
12100 tree structure.
12101
12102 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
12103 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
12104
12105 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
12106 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
12107 in your .emacs file.)
12108
12109 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
12110 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
12111
12112 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
12113 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
12114
12115 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
12116 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
12117 kills the region.
12118
12119 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
12120 delete the character before point, as usual.
12121
12122 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
12123 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
12124 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
12125
12126 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
12127 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
12128 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
12129 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
12130 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
12131 past.)
12132
12133 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
12134 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
12135 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
12136 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
12137 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
12138
12139 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
12140 and is an alias for it.
12141
12142 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
12143 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
12144
12145 ** Scrolling changes
12146
12147 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
12148 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
12149
12150 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
12151 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
12152 where it started.
12153
12154 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
12155 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
12156 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
12157 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
12158
12159 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
12160 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
12161 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
12162 recenters the window.
12163
12164 ** International character set support (MULE)
12165
12166 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
12167 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
12168 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
12169 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
12170 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
12171 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
12172
12173 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
12174 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
12175 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
12176 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
12177 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
12178
12179 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
12180 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
12181 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
12182 language, to make it possible to type them.
12183
12184 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
12185 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
12186
12187 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
12188 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
12189
12190 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
12191
12192 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
12193
12194 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
12195 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
12196 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
12197 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
12198 characters for their work until they want to change.
12199
12200 *** Input methods
12201
12202 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
12203 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
12204 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
12205 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
12206 support several input methods.
12207
12208 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
12209 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
12210 work.
12211
12212 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
12213 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
12214 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
12215 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
12216 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
12217 letter.
12218
12219 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
12220 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
12221 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
12222 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
12223 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
12224
12225 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
12226 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
12227 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
12228 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
12229
12230 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
12231 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
12232 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
12233 the first guess is wrong.
12234
12235 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
12236 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
12237
12238 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
12239 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
12240 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
12241 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
12242
12243 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
12244 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
12245 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
12246 translate automatically to and from either one.
12247
12248 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
12249
12250 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
12251 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
12252 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
12253 what you want.
12254
12255 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
12256 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
12257 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
12258 multibyte characters in that buffer.
12259
12260 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
12261 character conversion as well.
12262
12263 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
12264
12265 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
12266 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
12267 requires using many fonts.
12268
12269 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
12270 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
12271
12272 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
12273 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
12274 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
12275 you would use a font.
12276
12277 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
12278 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
12279 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
12280
12281 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
12282 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
12283 characters).
12284
12285 *** Defining fontsets.
12286
12287 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
12288 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
12289 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
12290
12291 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
12292 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
12293 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
12294 standard fontset are created automatically.
12295
12296 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
12297 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
12298 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
12299 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
12300 name is `fontset-startup'.
12301
12302 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
12303 The resource value should have this form:
12304 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
12305 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
12306 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
12307 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
12308 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
12309 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
12310 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
12311 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
12312 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
12313
12314 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
12315 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
12316 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
12317
12318 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
12319 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
12320 following resource,
12321 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
12322 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
12323 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
12324 Here is the substitution rule:
12325 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
12326 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
12327 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
12328 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
12329 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
12330
12331 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
12332 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
12333 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
12334
12335 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
12336 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
12337 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
12338 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
12339 fontsets.
12340
12341 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
12342 defaults for a particular choice of language.
12343
12344 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
12345 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
12346 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
12347 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
12348 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
12349 system for new files that you create.
12350
12351 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
12352 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
12353 whole Emacs session.
12354
12355 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
12356 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
12357 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
12358
12359 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
12360 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
12361 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
12362 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
12363 coding systems that Emacs supports.
12364
12365 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
12366 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
12367 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
12368 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
12369 is used for *the immediately following command*.
12370
12371 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
12372 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
12373
12374 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
12375 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
12376
12377 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
12378 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
12379
12380 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
12381 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
12382 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
12383 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
12384 of the file.
12385
12386 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
12387 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
12388 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
12389 translated into that character code.
12390
12391 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
12392 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
12393
12394 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
12395
12396 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
12397 the coding system for keyboard input.
12398
12399 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
12400 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
12401 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
12402
12403 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
12404
12405 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
12406 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
12407 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
12408 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
12409 designed to work with terminals.
12410
12411 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
12412 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
12413 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
12414 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
12415 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
12416 in the corresponding buffer.
12417
12418 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
12419
12420 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
12421 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
12422 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
12423
12424 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
12425 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
12426 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
12427 want to use.
12428
12429 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
12430 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
12431
12432 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
12433 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
12434 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
12435 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
12436
12437 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
12438 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
12439 related information.
12440
12441 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
12442 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
12443 scripts.
12444
12445 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
12446 information about the support for a particular language.
12447 You specify the language as an argument.
12448
12449 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
12450 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
12451 first dash.
12452
12453 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
12454 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
12455 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
12456 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
12457
12458 A alternativnyj (Russian)
12459 B big5 (Chinese)
12460 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
12461 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
12462 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
12463 E euc-japan (Japanese)
12464 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12465 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
12466 K euc-korea (Korean)
12467 R koi8 (Russian)
12468 Q tibetan
12469 S shift_jis (Japanese)
12470 T lao
12471 T tis620 (Thai)
12472 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
12473 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12474 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
12475 v viqr (Vietnamese)
12476 z hz (Chinese)
12477
12478 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
12479 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
12480 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
12481 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
12482
12483 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
12484 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
12485
12486 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
12487 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
12488 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
12489 Rmail files themselves.
12490
12491 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
12492 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
12493
12494 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12495 for sending mail:
12496
12497 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12498 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12499 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12500 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12501 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12502
12503 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12504 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12505 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12506 translations.
12507
12508 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12509 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12510 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12511 without any conversion.
12512
12513 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12514 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12515 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12516 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12517
12518 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12519 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12520
12521 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12522 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12523
12524 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12525 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12526
12527 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12528 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12529 in the buffer before point.
12530
12531 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12532 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12533 you are using.
12534
12535 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12536 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12537
12538 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12539
12540 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12541 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12542
12543 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12544 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12545 can become a bottleneck.
12546
12547 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12548 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12549 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12550 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12551 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12552 so useful that the change is worth while.
12553
12554 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12555 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12556 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12557 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12558
12559 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12560 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12561 show-paren-mode.
12562
12563 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12564 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12565 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12566
12567 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12568 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12569 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12570
12571 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12572 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12573 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12574
12575 ** Changes in View mode.
12576
12577 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12578 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12579
12580 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12581 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12582
12583 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12584 previous state.
12585
12586 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12587 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12588
12589 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12590 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12591 not just the selected window.
12592
12593 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12594 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12595 turns View mode on or off.
12596
12597 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12598 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12599 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12600
12601 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12602 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12603
12604 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12605 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12606 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12607 which version to compare with.
12608
12609 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12610 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12611
12612 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12613 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12614 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12615 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12616
12617 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12618 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12619 blocks, all of them or none.
12620
12621 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12622 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12623 confirmation first.
12624
12625 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12626 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12627 However, the mode will not be changed if
12628 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12629 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12630 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12631 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12632
12633 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12634
12635 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12636 these commands do not change the major mode.
12637
12638 ** M-x occur changes.
12639
12640 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12641 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12642
12643 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12644 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12645 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12646
12647 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12648 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12649 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12650 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12651 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12652
12653 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12654 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12655 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12656 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12657
12658 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12659 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12660 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12661
12662 ** Outline mode changes.
12663
12664 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12665
12666 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12667
12668 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12669 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12670 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12671 was already active.
12672
12673 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12674 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12675 get confused by it.
12676
12677 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12678 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12679
12680 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12681
12682 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12683 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12684 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12685 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12686
12687 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12688 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12689 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12690
12691 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12692 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12693 values.
12694
12695 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12696 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12697 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12698 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12699
12700 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12701 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12702 can be. The default value is 30.
12703
12704 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12705
12706 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12707 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12708 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12709 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12710 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12711 behavior.
12712
12713 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12714 compose-mail-other-frame.
12715
12716 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12717 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12718 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12719 buffer that shows the original message.
12720
12721 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12722 with separator lines around the contents.
12723
12724 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12725 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12726 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12727 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12728
12729 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12730
12731 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12732 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12733 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12734 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12735
12736 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12737 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12738 /etc/passwd.
12739
12740 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12741 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12742 /etc/passwd.
12743
12744 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12745 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12746 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12747 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12748
12749 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12750 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12751 be taken to be magic.
12752
12753 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12754 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12755 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12756
12757 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12758 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12759
12760 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12761 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12762
12763 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12764
12765 new key dired.el binding old key
12766 ------- ---------------- -------
12767 * c dired-change-marks c
12768 * m dired-mark m
12769 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12770 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12771 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12772 * u dired-unmark u
12773 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12774 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12775 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12776 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12777 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12778 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12779
12780 ** Rmail changes.
12781
12782 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12783 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12784 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12785 each time you run it.
12786
12787 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12788 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12789
12790 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12791 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12792 means to move in the opposite direction.
12793
12794 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12795 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12796
12797 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12798 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12799 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12800 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12801 for output.
12802
12803 ** Gnus changes.
12804
12805 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12806
12807 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12808 Gnus.
12809
12810 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12811 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12812
12813 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12814 article mode line.
12815
12816 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12817
12818 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12819
12820 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12821
12822 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12823 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12824 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12825
12826 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12827
12828 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12829
12830 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12831 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12832
12833 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12834 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12835 used to pick articles.
12836
12837 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12838 another have been added.
12839
12840 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12841
12842 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12843 generating lines in buffers.
12844
12845 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12846 `C-M-_'.
12847
12848 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12849
12850 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12851
12852 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12853
12854 *** Scores can be decayed.
12855
12856 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12857
12858 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12859 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12860
12861 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12862 the native server.
12863
12864 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12865
12866 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12867 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12868
12869 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12870
12871 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12872 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12873
12874 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12875 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12876
12877 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12878 a group.
12879
12880 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12881 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12882
12883 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
12884
12885 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
12886
12887 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
12888
12889 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
12890
12891 Use the `Y c' command.
12892
12893 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
12894
12895 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
12896
12897 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
12898
12899 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
12900 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
12901
12902 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12903
12904 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12905
12906 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12907 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12908
12909 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12910
12911 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12912 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12913 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12914 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12915 this issue.)
12916
12917 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12918 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12919 particular news group. This can be done by:
12920
12921 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12922
12923 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12924 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12925 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12926 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12927 for reading and posting).
12928
12929 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12930 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12931 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12932 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12933 there.
12934
12935 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12936 default. Here are some of these default settings:
12937
12938 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12939 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12940 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12941 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12942 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12943
12944 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12945 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12946
12947 ** CC mode changes.
12948
12949 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12950 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12951 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12952 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12953 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12954 loaded.
12955
12956 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12957 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12958 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12959 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12960 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12961 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
12962
12963 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
12964 of the current buffer.
12965
12966 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
12967 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
12968 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
12969
12970 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
12971 style that the Python developers like.
12972
12973 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
12974 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
12975 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
12976
12977 ** VC Changes [new]
12978
12979 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
12980 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
12981 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
12982
12983 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
12984 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
12985 developers.
12986
12987 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
12988 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
12989
12990 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
12991 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
12992 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
12993 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
12994
12995 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
12996 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
12997
12998 ** Calendar changes.
12999
13000 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
13001 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
13002 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
13003 following/previous years.
13004
13005 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
13006 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
13007 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
13008 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
13009 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
13010 supposed attribute of God.
13011
13012 ** ps-print changes
13013
13014 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
13015 layout.
13016
13017 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
13018
13019 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
13020 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
13021 printer system has this behavior, set variable
13022 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
13023
13024 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
13025 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
13026 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
13027
13028 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
13029 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
13030
13031 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
13032 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
13033 printing for your printer.
13034
13035 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
13036 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13037
13038 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
13039 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13040
13041 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
13042 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
13043 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
13044 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
13045 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
13046 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
13047 The default value is nil.
13048
13049 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
13050 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
13051
13052 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
13053 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
13054 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
13055 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
13056 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
13057 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
13058 color). The default is 0 ("black").
13059
13060 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
13061 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
13062
13063 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
13064 The default is 0 ("black").
13065
13066 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
13067 The default is 0 ("black").
13068
13069 border-width Specify the border width.
13070 The default is 0.4.
13071
13072 Any other property is ignored.
13073
13074 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
13075 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
13076 documentation).
13077
13078 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
13079 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
13080 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
13081 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
13082 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
13083 controlling headers.
13084
13085 *** Color management (subgroup)
13086
13087 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
13088 color.
13089
13090 *** Face Management (subgroup)
13091
13092 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
13093 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
13094 background should be used. Valid values are:
13095
13096 t always use face background color.
13097 nil never use face background color.
13098 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
13099
13100 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
13101
13102 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
13103 sheet of paper.
13104
13105 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
13106 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
13107
13108 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
13109 each page.
13110
13111 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
13112 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
13113 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
13114
13115 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
13116 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
13117 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
13118
13119 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
13120 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
13121 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
13122
13123 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
13124 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
13125 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
13126
13127 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
13128 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
13129 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
13130
13131 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
13132
13133 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
13134
13135 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
13136 RGB color.
13137
13138 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
13139 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
13140 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
13141
13142 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
13143 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13144 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13145 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13146 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13147 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
13148 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
13149 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
13150 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13151 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13152 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13153 10 + 10 +
13154 11 + 11 +
13155 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13156 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13157 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
13158 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
13159 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
13160 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13161 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13162 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13163 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
13164 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
13165 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
13166 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
13167 22 + 22 +
13168 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13169
13170 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
13171
13172
13173 *** Printer management (subgroup)
13174
13175 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
13176 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
13177 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
13178 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
13179 to "-P".
13180
13181 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
13182 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
13183 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
13184
13185 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
13186 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
13187 do so.
13188
13189 *** Page settings (subgroup)
13190
13191 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
13192 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
13193 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
13194 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
13195 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
13196 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
13197 `setpagedevice'.
13198
13199 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
13200 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
13201 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
13202
13203 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
13204 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
13205 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
13206 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
13207 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
13208 its TO, are ignored.
13209
13210 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
13211 pages. Valid values are:
13212
13213 nil print all pages.
13214
13215 `even-page' print only even pages.
13216
13217 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
13218
13219 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
13220 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13221 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
13222 print only the even sheet of paper.
13223
13224 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
13225 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13226 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
13227 only the odd sheet of paper.
13228
13229 Any other value is treated as nil.
13230
13231 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
13232 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
13233 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
13234
13235 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
13236
13237 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
13238 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
13239
13240 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
13241 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13242 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
13243 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13244 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13245 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13246 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13247
13248 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
13249 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13250 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
13251 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
13252 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
13253 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
13254 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
13255
13256 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
13257
13258 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
13259 messages should be sent.
13260
13261 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
13262 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
13263 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
13264
13265 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
13266
13267 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
13268 points for line numbers.
13269
13270 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
13271 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
13272
13273 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
13274 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
13275 to 2, the printing will look like:
13276
13277 1 one line
13278 one line
13279 3 one line
13280 one line
13281 5 one line
13282 one line
13283 ...
13284
13285 Valid values are:
13286
13287 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
13288 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
13289 is used.
13290
13291 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
13292 zebra stripe is to be printed.
13293
13294 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
13295
13296 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
13297 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
13298 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
13299 3, the output will look like:
13300
13301 one line
13302 one line
13303 3 one line
13304 one line
13305 one line
13306 6 one line
13307 one line
13308 one line
13309 9 one line
13310 one line
13311 ...
13312
13313 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
13314 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
13315
13316 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
13317 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13318 `ps-font-size').
13319
13320 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
13321 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13322 `ps-font-size').
13323
13324 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
13325
13326 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
13327 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
13328
13329 ** hideshow changes.
13330
13331 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
13332 C++, ; for lisp).
13333
13334 *** Support for java-mode added.
13335
13336 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
13337 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
13338
13339 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
13340 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
13341 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
13342
13343 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
13344 robust and a lot faster.
13345
13346 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
13347
13348 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
13349 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
13350 documentation for more details.
13351
13352 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
13353
13354 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
13355 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
13356 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
13357 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
13358 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
13359
13360 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
13361 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
13362 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
13363 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
13364
13365 ** Font Lock mode
13366
13367 *** Custom support
13368
13369 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
13370 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify
13371 the faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new
13372 custom group font-lock-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in your
13373 ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
13374 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
13375
13376 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
13377
13378 *** Maximum decoration
13379
13380 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
13381 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
13382 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
13383 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
13384 to get the old behavior.
13385
13386 *** New support
13387
13388 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
13389
13390 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
13391 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
13392
13393 *** Configurable support
13394
13395 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
13396 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
13397 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
13398 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
13399 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
13400 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
13401 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
13402
13403 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
13404 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
13405 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
13406
13407 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
13408
13409 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
13410 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
13411 for any mode.
13412
13413 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
13414
13415 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
13416
13417 in your ~/.emacs.
13418
13419 *** New faces
13420
13421 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
13422 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
13423 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
13424 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
13425
13426 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
13427
13428 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
13429 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
13430 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
13431
13432 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
13433
13434 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
13435 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
13436 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
13437 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
13438 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
13439 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
13440 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
13441
13442 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
13443 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
13444 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
13445 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
13446 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
13447 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
13448
13449 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
13450
13451 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
13452 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
13453 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
13454 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
13455
13456 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
13457 settings.
13458
13459 ** Ada mode changes.
13460
13461 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
13462 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
13463 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
13464 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
13465 stubs.
13466
13467 *** There are two new commands:
13468 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
13469 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
13470
13471 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
13472 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
13473 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
13474
13475 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
13476 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
13477 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
13478
13479 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
13480 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
13481 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
13482 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
13483
13484 ** Scheme mode changes.
13485
13486 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
13487 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
13488 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
13489 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
13490 have any effect.
13491
13492 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
13493 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13494 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13495 variables as buffer-local variables.
13496
13497 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13498 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13499
13500 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13501
13502 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13503 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13504 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13505 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13506
13507 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13508 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13509 buffer in Emacs.
13510
13511 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13512 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13513 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13514 option takes precedence.
13515
13516 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13517 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13518 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13519
13520 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13521 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13522 the current defun.
13523
13524 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13525 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13526
13527 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13528 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13529 necessary).
13530
13531 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13532 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13533 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13534 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13535 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13536 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13537
13538 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13539 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13540 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13541 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13542
13543 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13544 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13545 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13546 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13547 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13548
13549 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13550 since it applies only to the current frame.
13551
13552 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13553 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13554 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13555
13556 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13557 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13558 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13559 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13560 instead of just the file you are editing.
13561
13562 ** RefTeX mode
13563
13564 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13565 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13566 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13567 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13568 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13569
13570 C-c ( reftex-label
13571 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13572 knows which kind of label is needed.
13573
13574 C-c ) reftex-reference
13575 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13576 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13577
13578 C-c [ reftex-citation
13579 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13580 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13581
13582 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13583 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13584
13585 C-c = reftex-toc
13586 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13587 can quickly jump to every section.
13588
13589 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13590 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13591 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13592 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13593 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13594
13595 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13596
13597 *** Info documentation is now available.
13598
13599 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13600 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13601
13602 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13603 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13604
13605 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13606 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13607
13608 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13609 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13610 appropriate functions.
13611
13612 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13613 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13614
13615 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13616 been cleaned.
13617
13618 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13619 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13620
13621 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13622 shall be delimited.
13623
13624 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13625 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13626 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13627
13628 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13629 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13630 prefixed with `ALT'.
13631
13632 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13633 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13634 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13635 documentation).
13636
13637 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13638 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13639 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13640
13641 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13642 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13643
13644 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13645 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13646 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13647
13648 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13649
13650 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13651
13652 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13653 from alien sources.
13654
13655 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13656 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13657 crossref entries.
13658
13659 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13660 region.
13661
13662 *** Added support for imenu.
13663
13664 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13665 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13666 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13667 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13668
13669 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13670 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13671
13672 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13673
13674 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13675
13676 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13677 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13678 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13679 as an argument.
13680
13681 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13682 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13683
13684 ** browse-url changes
13685
13686 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13687 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13688 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13689 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13690 customization variables.
13691
13692 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13693
13694 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13695 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13696 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13697
13698 ** Changes in Ediff
13699
13700 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13701 pops up the Info file for this command.
13702
13703 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13704 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13705 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13706 directories).
13707
13708 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13709 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13710 files in the same directory.
13711
13712 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13713 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13714 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13715
13716 ** Changes in Viper
13717
13718 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13719 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13720 instead of vip-.
13721 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13722 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13723 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13724 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13725 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13726 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13727 color when Viper is in insert state.
13728 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13729 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13730 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13731
13732 ** Etags changes.
13733
13734 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13735 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13736 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13737 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13738 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13739
13740 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13741
13742 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13743 constructs are tagged. Files are recognized by the extension .java.
13744
13745 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13746 recognized by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13747 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13748
13749 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13750 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13751 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13752 methods and protocols.
13753
13754 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognized by the extension
13755 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13756 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13757 paragraph name.
13758
13759 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13760 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13761 at least M times and as many as N times.
13762
13763 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13764 in files has changed slightly.
13765
13766 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13767 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13768 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13769 with old time-stamp-format values.
13770
13771 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13772 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13773 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13774 reasons.
13775
13776 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13777 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13778 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13779 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13780 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13781 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13782
13783 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13784 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13785 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13786
13787 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13788 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13789 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13790 recommended now will continue to work then.
13791
13792 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13793 details.
13794
13795 ** There are some additional major modes:
13796
13797 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13798 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13799 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13800
13801 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13802 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13803 into Emacs.
13804
13805 ** New Lisp packages include:
13806
13807 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13808
13809 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13810 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13811
13812 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13813
13814 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13815 in shell buffers.
13816
13817 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13818 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13819 and `elint-defun'.
13820
13821 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13822 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13823 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13824 strings or comments.
13825
13826 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13827 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13828 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13829 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13830 at these points.
13831
13832 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13833 can visit them by short forms of their names.
13834
13835 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13836 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13837
13838 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13839
13840 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13841 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13842
13843 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13844
13845 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13846
13847 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13848
13849 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13850 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13851
13852 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13853 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13854 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13855 original place after inserting the copy.
13856
13857 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13858 on the buffer.
13859
13860 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13861 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13862 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13863
13864 Enable mouse-drag with:
13865 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13866 -or-
13867 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13868
13869 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13870 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13871
13872 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13873 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13874
13875 *** ogonek
13876
13877 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13878 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13879 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13880 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13881 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13882 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
13883 instance) and vice versa.
13884
13885 To use this package load it using
13886 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
13887 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
13888 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
13889 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
13890 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
13891 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
13892
13893 *** Interface to ph.
13894
13895 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
13896
13897 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
13898 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
13899 these servers.
13900
13901 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13902
13903 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13904 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13905 while the real cursor does not move.
13906
13907 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13908 for visiting your favorite web sites.
13909
13910 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13911 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13912
13913 ** movemail change
13914
13915 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13916 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13917 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13918 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13919
13920 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
13921 \f
13922 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13923
13924 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13925
13926 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13927 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13928 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13929 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13930 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13931
13932 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13933 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13934 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13935 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13936 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13937 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
13938 \f
13939 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13940
13941 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13942 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13943 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13944 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13945
13946 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13947 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13948
13949 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13950 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13951 "win".
13952
13953 ** Basic Lisp changes
13954
13955 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13956 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13957
13958 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13959 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13960 or by the user.
13961
13962 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
13963
13964 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
13965
13966 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
13967 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
13968
13969 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
13970 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
13971 its argument.
13972
13973 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
13974
13975 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
13976
13977 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
13978
13979 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
13980 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
13981 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
13982 `format' function.
13983
13984 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
13985 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
13986 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
13987
13988 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
13989 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
13990 adding one of these suffixes.
13991
13992 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
13993 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
13994 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
13995
13996 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
13997 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
13998
13999 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
14000
14001 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
14002 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
14003
14004 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
14005 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
14006
14007 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
14008
14009 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
14010 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
14011
14012 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
14013 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
14014 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
14015 works using `save-current-buffer'.
14016
14017 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
14018 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
14019 of the last form.
14020
14021 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
14022 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
14023 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
14024 as the last form.
14025
14026 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
14027 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
14028 matches.
14029
14030 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
14031
14032 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
14033 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
14034 Then it returns that string.
14035
14036 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
14037
14038 (with-output-to-string
14039 (princ "The buffer is ")
14040 (princ (buffer-name)))
14041
14042 returns "The buffer is foo".
14043
14044 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
14045 is non-nil.
14046
14047 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
14048 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
14049 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
14050
14051 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
14052 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
14053
14054 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
14055 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
14056 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
14057 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
14058 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
14059 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
14060
14061 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
14062 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
14063 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
14064 characters".
14065
14066 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
14067 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
14068 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
14069 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
14070 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
14071
14072 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
14073 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
14074 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
14075 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
14076
14077 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
14078 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
14079
14080 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
14081
14082 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
14083 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
14084 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
14085 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
14086 guaranteed.
14087
14088 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
14089 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
14090 character).
14091
14092 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
14093
14094 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
14095 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
14096 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
14097 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
14098 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
14099
14100 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
14101
14102 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
14103 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
14104 more than the number of characters.
14105
14106 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
14107 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
14108 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
14109 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
14110 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
14111 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
14112
14113 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
14114 and returns a string containing those characters.
14115
14116 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
14117 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
14118 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
14119 character, sref signals an error.
14120
14121 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
14122 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
14123 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14124
14125 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
14126 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
14127 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14128
14129 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
14130 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
14131 to a vector of the characters in it.
14132
14133 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
14134 of a string. You call it as follows:
14135
14136 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
14137
14138 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
14139 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
14140 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
14141 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
14142 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
14143
14144 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
14145 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14146
14147 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
14148 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14149
14150 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
14151 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
14152 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
14153 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
14154
14155 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
14156
14157 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
14158
14159 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
14160 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
14161 are not included in the resulting value.
14162
14163 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
14164 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
14165 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
14166 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
14167
14168 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
14169 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
14170 character extends across that column), then the padding character
14171 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
14172 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
14173 column START-COLUMN.
14174
14175 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
14176 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
14177 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
14178 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
14179 changed text, before the change.
14180
14181 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
14182 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
14183 one character set for each script, not for each language.
14184
14185 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
14186
14187 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
14188
14189 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
14190 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
14191
14192 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
14193 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
14194 which identify the character within that character set.
14195
14196 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
14197 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
14198 opposite of split-char.
14199
14200 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
14201 of all the characters between BEG and END.
14202
14203 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
14204 of all the characters in a string.
14205
14206 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
14207 and specifying coding systems.
14208
14209 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
14210 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
14211 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
14212 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
14213 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
14214 as what to do about code conversion.)
14215
14216 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
14217 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
14218
14219 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14220 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14221 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
14222
14223 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14224 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
14225 to match against a file name.
14226
14227 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14228 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14229 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14230 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14231 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14232 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14233
14234 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14235 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14236
14237 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
14238 the coding system to use for network sockets.
14239
14240 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14241 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
14242 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
14243 service names.
14244
14245 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14246 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14247 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14248 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14249 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14250 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14251
14252 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14253 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14254
14255 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14256 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14257 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
14258 start the subprocess.
14259
14260 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
14261 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
14262 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
14263 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
14264 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
14265
14266 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
14267 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
14268 subprocess.
14269
14270 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
14271 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
14272 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
14273 connection permanently or until overridden.
14274
14275 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
14276 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
14277 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
14278 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
14279 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
14280 system for one operation at a time.
14281
14282 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
14283 files, subprocesses or network connections.
14284
14285 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
14286 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
14287 The value is a cons cell,
14288 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
14289 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
14290 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
14291 input to the subprocess.
14292
14293 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
14294 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
14295
14296 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
14297 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
14298 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
14299
14300 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
14301 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
14302 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
14303 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
14304 customization.
14305
14306 Thus, instead of writing
14307
14308 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
14309 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
14310
14311 you would now write this:
14312
14313 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
14314 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
14315 :type 'boolean
14316 :group foo)
14317
14318 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
14319 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
14320 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
14321 for a description of them.
14322
14323 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
14324 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
14325
14326 (defgroup ispell nil
14327 "Spell checking using Ispell."
14328 :group 'processes)
14329
14330 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
14331 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
14332 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
14333 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
14334 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
14335
14336 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
14337 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
14338 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
14339 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
14340 first-level subgroups.
14341
14342 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
14343
14344 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
14345 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
14346
14347 ** easy-mmode
14348
14349 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
14350 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
14351 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
14352 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
14353 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
14354 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
14355
14356 ** Text property changes
14357
14358 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
14359 text property.
14360
14361 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
14362 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
14363 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
14364 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
14365 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
14366
14367 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
14368 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
14369 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
14370 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
14371
14372 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
14373 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
14374 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
14375
14376 ** Changes in invisibility features
14377
14378 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
14379 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
14380 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
14381 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
14382 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
14383 make the overlay visible.
14384
14385 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
14386 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
14387 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
14388 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
14389 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
14390 t when it should hide it.
14391
14392 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
14393
14394 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
14395 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
14396 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
14397 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
14398 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
14399 Here is an example of how to do this:
14400
14401 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
14402 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14403 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
14404 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14405
14406 ...
14407 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
14408
14409 ...
14410 ;; When done with the overlays:
14411 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14412 ;; Or respectively:
14413 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14414
14415 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
14416
14417 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
14418 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
14419 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
14420 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
14421
14422 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
14423 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
14424 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
14425
14426 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
14427 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
14428
14429 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
14430 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
14431
14432 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
14433 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
14434 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
14435
14436 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
14437 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
14438 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
14439 determine the syntax type of the character.
14440
14441 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
14442 of the current buffer.
14443
14444 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
14445 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
14446 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
14447
14448 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
14449 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
14450 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
14451 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
14452 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
14453
14454 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
14455 text property.
14456
14457 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
14458 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
14459 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
14460
14461 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
14462 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
14463 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
14464 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
14465 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
14466
14467 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
14468 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
14469 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
14470
14471 ** Changes in face features
14472
14473 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
14474 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
14475
14476 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
14477 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
14478
14479 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
14480 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
14481
14482 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
14483 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
14484
14485 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
14486 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
14487 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
14488 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
14489 overlay property).
14490
14491 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
14492 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
14493
14494 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14495
14496 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14497 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14498 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14499 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14500
14501 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14502 begins with ~.
14503
14504 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14505 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14506
14507 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14508 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14509
14510 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14511 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14512
14513 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14514 character code conversion as well as other things.
14515
14516 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14517 (formerly it did not).
14518
14519 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14520 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14521
14522 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14523 instead of constant strings.
14524
14525 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14526 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14527 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14528
14529 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14530 in the same way as before.
14531
14532 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14533 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14534 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14535
14536 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14537 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14538 else, and returns nil.
14539
14540 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14541 directory cannot be listed.
14542
14543 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14544
14545 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14546 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14547 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14548 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14549 ways:
14550
14551 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14552 It is available through the history command M-n.
14553
14554 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14555 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14556 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14557 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14558 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14559
14560 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14561 argument in this way.
14562
14563 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14564 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14565 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14566
14567 ** Echo area features
14568
14569 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14570 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14571 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14572 after the echo area is cleared.
14573
14574 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14575 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14576
14577 ** Keyboard input features
14578
14579 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14580 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14581
14582 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14583 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14584 by keyboard macros.
14585
14586 ** Frame-related changes
14587
14588 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14589 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14590 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14591
14592 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14593 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14594 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14595
14596 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14597 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14598 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14599 in the selected frame.
14600
14601 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14602 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14603 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14604
14605 ** X Windows features
14606
14607 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14608 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14609 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14610
14611 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14612 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14613
14614 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14615 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14616 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14617
14618 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14619 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14620
14621 ** Subprocess features
14622
14623 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14624 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14625 automatically.
14626
14627 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14628 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14629
14630 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14631 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14632
14633 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14634 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14635
14636 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14637 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14638 goes after the other menu items.
14639
14640 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14641 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14642 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14643 are in use.
14644
14645 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14646 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14647
14648 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14649 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14650 form.
14651
14652 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14653 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14654 but its hook is still run.
14655
14656 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14657 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14658
14659 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14660 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14661 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14662
14663 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14664 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14665 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14666 warned.
14667
14668 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14669 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14670
14671 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14672 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14673 functions like display-time.
14674
14675 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14676 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14677
14678 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14679 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14680 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14681
14682 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14683 if there is an error in compilation.
14684
14685 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14686 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14687 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14688 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14689
14690 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14691 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14692 the *scratch* buffer.
14693
14694 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14695 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14696 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14697 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14698
14699 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14700 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14701 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14702
14703 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14704 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14705 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14706 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14707
14708 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14709 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14710 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14711
14712 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14713 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14714 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14715 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14716 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14717 files at all.
14718
14719 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14720 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14721 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14722 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14723
14724 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14725 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14726 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14727 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14728
14729 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14730
14731 ** imenu.el changes.
14732
14733 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14734 item from menu created by imenu.
14735
14736 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14737 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14738 select one of those items.
14739 \f
14740 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14741
14742 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14743 Copyright information:
14744
14745 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004,
14746 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14747
14748 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14749 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14750 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14751 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14752
14753 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14754 of this document, or of portions of it,
14755 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14756 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14757 \f
14758 Local variables:
14759 mode: outline
14760 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14761 end:
14762
14763 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793